]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
re PR other/44034 (target hooks are hard to maintain)
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050
JR
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94@node Driver
95@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96@cindex driver
97@cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99@c prevent bad page break with this line
100You can control the compilation driver.
101
102@defmac SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
103A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
104takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
105option takes--zero, for many options.
106
107By default, this macro is defined as
108@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
109properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
110wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
111should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
112additional options.
113@end defmac
114
115@defmac WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
116A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
117takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
118option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
119@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
120
121By default, this macro is defined as
122@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
123properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
124wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
125should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
126additional options.
127@end defmac
128
129@defmac SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
130A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
131stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
132boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
133generated, zero otherwise.
134
135By default, this macro is defined as
136@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
137options properly. You need not define
138@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
139options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
140should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
141for additional options.
142@end defmac
143
144@defmac TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
145If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
146potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
147second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
148supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
149target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
150are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
151must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
152provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
153such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
154multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @option{-malt-abi},
155@option{-EB}, and @option{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
156
157@smallexample
158#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
159@{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
160@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
161@end smallexample
162@end defmac
163
164@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
165A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
166initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
167
168The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
169default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
170choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
171applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
172options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
173using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
174
175This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
176options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
177that the other specs are easier to write.
178
179Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
180@end defmac
181
182@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
183A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
184@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
185for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
186outermost pair of surrounding braces.
187
188The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
189the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
190to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
191@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
192everywhere it occurs.
193
194The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
195default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
196the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac CPP_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
203pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
204give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
205
206Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
207@end defmac
208
209@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
210This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
211than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
212@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
213@end defmac
214
215@defmac CC1_SPEC
216A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
217pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
218front ends.
219It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
220for GCC to pass to front ends.
221
222Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
223@end defmac
224
225@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
226A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
227pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
228give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
229
230Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
231Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
232@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
233CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
234@end defmac
235
236@defmac ASM_SPEC
237A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
238pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
239you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
240See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
241
242Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
243@end defmac
244
245@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
246A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
247run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
248Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
249an example of this.
250
251Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
252@end defmac
253
254@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
255Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
256an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
257read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
258output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
259@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
260
261If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
262standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
263cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
264see @file{mips.h} for instance.
265@end defmac
266
267@defmac LINK_SPEC
268A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
269pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
270give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
271
272Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
273@end defmac
274
275@defmac LIB_SPEC
276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
277between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
278command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
281loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282@end defmac
283
284@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
285Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
286how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
287linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
288the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
289
290If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
291passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
295By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
296@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
297instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
298depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
299@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
300targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
301@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
302driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
303line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
304@end defmac
305
306@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
307A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
308mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
309generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
310static exception handler library, when linking without any of
311@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
312@end defmac
313
314@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
315If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
316When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
317the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
318@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
319@end defmac
320
321@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
322Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
323difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
324the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
325
326If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
327standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
328@end defmac
329
330@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
331Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
332difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
333the very end of the command given to the linker.
334
335Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
336@end defmac
337
338@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
339GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
340However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
341models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
342@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
343blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
344default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
345@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
346@end defmac
347
348@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
349Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
350configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
351et al, within sysroot+suffix.
352@end defmac
353
354@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
355Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
356GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
357updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
358usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
359@end defmac
360
361@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
362Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
363@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
364@code{CC1_SPEC}.
365
366The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
367containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
368string constant that provides the specification.
369
370Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
371
372@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
373related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
374to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
375these definitions.
376
377For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
378define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
379used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
380used.
381
382The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
383
384@smallexample
385#define EXTRA_SPECS \
386 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
387
388#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
389@end smallexample
390
391The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
392@smallexample
393#undef CPP_SPEC
394#define CPP_SPEC \
395"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
396%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
397%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
398%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
399
400#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
401#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
402@end smallexample
403
404while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
405@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
406
407@smallexample
408#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
409#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
410@end smallexample
411@end defmac
412
413@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
414Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
415@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
416the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
417@end defmac
418
419@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
420The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
421By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
422@end defmac
423
424@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
425A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
426linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
427change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
428define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
429line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
430the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
431@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
435A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
436directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
437removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
441Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
442string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
443target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
444@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
445
446Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
447the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
448@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
449@xref{Target Fragment}.
450@end defmac
451
452@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
453Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
454a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
455indicates an absolute file name.
456@end defmac
457
458@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
459If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
460@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
461when the compiler is built as a cross
462compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
463to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
464@end defmac
465
466@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
467Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
469try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
470@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
471is built as a cross compiler.
472@end defmac
473
474@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
475Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
476standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
477when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
478@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
479is built as a cross compiler.
480@end defmac
481
482@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
483Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
484standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
485default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
486@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
487is built as a cross compiler.
488@end defmac
489
490@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
491If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
492standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
493compiler is built as a cross compiler.
494@end defmac
495
496@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
497If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
498standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
499cross compiler.
500@end defmac
501
502@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
503Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
504variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
505loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
506initialize the necessary environment variables.
507@end defmac
508
509@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
510Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
511standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
512try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
513comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
514
515Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
516replacement.
517@end defmac
518
519@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
520Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
521system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
522directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
523@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
524
525Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
526specified.
527@end defmac
528
529@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
530Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
531standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
532try when searching for header files.
533
534Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
535@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
536@end defmac
537
538@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
539The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
540See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
541If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
542@end defmac
543
544@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
545Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
546for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
547usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
548@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
549@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
550and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
551and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
552@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
553
554The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
555Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
556string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
557for C++-only directories,
558and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
559wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
560the array with a null element.
561
562The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
563if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
564or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
565operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
566
567For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
568
569@smallexample
570#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
571@{ \
572 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
573 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
574 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
575 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
576 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
577@}
578@end smallexample
579@end defmac
580
581Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
582
583@enumerate
584@item
585Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
586
587@item
588The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
589is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
590@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
591
592@item
593The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
594
595@item
596The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
597in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
598
599@item
600The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
601
602@item
603The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
604
605@item
606The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
607compiler.
608@end enumerate
609
610Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
611
612@enumerate
613@item
614Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
615
616@item
617The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
618value based on the installed toolchain location.
619
620@item
621The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
622(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
623
624@item
625The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
626in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
627
628@item
629The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
630
631@item
632The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
633compiler.
634
635@item
636The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
637native compiler, or we have a target system root.
638
639@item
640The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
641native compiler, or we have a target system root.
642
643@item
644The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
645If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
646the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
647
648@item
649The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
650compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
651@file{/lib/}.
652
653@item
654The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
655compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
656@file{/usr/lib/}.
657@end enumerate
658
659@node Run-time Target
660@section Run-time Target Specification
661@cindex run-time target specification
662@cindex predefined macros
663@cindex target specifications
664
665@c prevent bad page break with this line
666Here are run-time target specifications.
667
668@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
669This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
670built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
671the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
672@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
673calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
674finished command line option processing your code can use those
675results freely.
676
677@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
678command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
679the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
680accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
681
682@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
683object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
684@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
685defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
686with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
687only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
688example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
689and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
690@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
691defines only @code{_ABI64}.
692
693You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
694@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
695or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
696assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
697macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
698to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
699variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
700@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
701preprocessing.
702@end defmac
703
704@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
705Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
706and is used for the target operating system instead.
707@end defmac
708
709@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
710Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
711and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
712macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
713it yourself.
714@end defmac
715
716@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
717This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
718any target-specific headers.
719@end deftypevar
720
721@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
722This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
723Its default setting is 0.
724@end deftypevr
725
726@cindex optional hardware or system features
727@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
728
729@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
730This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
731target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
732(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
733processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
734definition does nothing but return true.
735
736@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
737associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
738the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
739underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
740no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
741(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
742argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
743option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
744@end deftypefn
745
746@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
747This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
748target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
749definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
750option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
751valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
752default definition does nothing but return false.
753
754In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
755options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
756only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
757should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
758@end deftypefn
759
760@defmac TARGET_VERSION
761This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
762describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
763description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
764
765@smallexample
766#ifdef MOTOROLA
767#define TARGET_VERSION \
768 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
769#else
770#define TARGET_VERSION \
771 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
772#endif
773@end smallexample
774@end defmac
775
776@defmac OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
777Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
778a particular target machine. You can define a macro
779@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this. This macro, if
780defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
781parsed.
782
783Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
784@option{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
785
786If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
787changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
788@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
789
790This macros is obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
791@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} instead.
792@end defmac
793
794@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
795This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
796but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
797pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
798attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
799when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
800actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
801@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
802@end deftypefn
803
804@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
805This is similar to @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} but is only used in the C
806language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
807used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
808frontends.
809@end defmac
810
811@defmac OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
812Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
813various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once
814just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
815of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
816used as the default values for the other command line options.
817
818@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
819specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
820
821@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
822
823This macro is run once at program startup and when the optimization
824options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
825@code{optimize} attribute.
826
827@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
828this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
829generated code.
830@end defmac
831
832@hook TARGET_HELP
833This hook is called in response to the user invoking
834@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
835chance to display extra information on the target specific command
836line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
837@end deftypefn
838
839@defmac CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
840Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
841pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
842@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
843@end defmac
844
845@node Per-Function Data
846@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
847@cindex per-function data
848@cindex data structures
849
850If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
851provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
852using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
853nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
854when another one comes along.
855
856GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
857contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
858structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
859@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
860to their own specific data.
861
862If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
863@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
864This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
865@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
866
867One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
868RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
869RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
870function, for level 0.
871
872Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
873all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
874function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
875stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
876stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
877@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
878the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
879single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
880longer supported.
881
882@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
883Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
884is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
885The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
886function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
887@end defmac
888
889@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
890If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
891function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
892target to perform any target specific initialization of the
893@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
894used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
895
896@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
897Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
898GC allocation, including the structure itself.
899@end deftypevar
900
901@node Storage Layout
902@section Storage Layout
903@cindex storage layout
904
905Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
906alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
907expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
908@xref{Run-time Target}.
909
910@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
911Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
912byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
913This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
914bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
915be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
916macro need not be a constant.
917
918This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
919bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
920@end defmac
921
922@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
923Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
924word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
925@end defmac
926
927@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
928Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
929most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
930memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
931order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
932macro need not be a constant.
933@end defmac
934
935@defmac LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
936Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
937constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
938used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
939based on preprocessor defines.
940@end defmac
941
942@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
943Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
944@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
945containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
946have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
947
948You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
949multi-word integers.
950@end defmac
951
952@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
953Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
954unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
955@end defmac
956
957@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
958Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
959is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
960@end defmac
961
962@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
963Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
964@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
965largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
966@end defmac
967
968@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
969Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
970register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
971@end defmac
972
973@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
974Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
975@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
976smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
977@end defmac
978
979@defmac UNITS_PER_SIMD_WORD (@var{mode})
980Number of units in the vectors that the vectorizer can produce for
981scalar mode @var{mode}. The default is equal to @code{UNITS_PER_WORD},
982because the vectorizer can do some transformations even in absence of
983specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
984@end defmac
985
986@defmac POINTER_SIZE
987Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
988width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
989you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
990a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
991@end defmac
992
993@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
994A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
995@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
996greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
997should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
998is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
999@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
1000
1001You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
1002and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
1003@end defmac
1004
1005@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
1006A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
1007is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
1008stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
1009scalar type.
1010
1011On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
1012register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
1013@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
1014cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
1015floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
1016counterparts.
1017
1018For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
1019However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
1020either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
1021the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
1022sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
1023@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
1024
1025Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
1026@end defmac
1027
1028@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
1029Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
1030function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
1031and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
1032change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
1033pointer} types.
1034
1035@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
1036return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
1037@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
1038If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
1039which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
1040then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
1041the signedness may be different.
1042
1043The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
1044also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
1045if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1046@end deftypefn
1047
1048@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
1049Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1050bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1051regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1052size of an integer.
1053@end defmac
1054
1055@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
1056Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1057stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1058desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1059if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1060this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1061@end defmac
1062
1063@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1064Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1065stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1066is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1067macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1068@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1069@end defmac
1070
1071@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1072Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1073from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1074to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1075@end defmac
1076
1077@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1078Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1079@end defmac
1080
1081@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1082Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1083bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1084just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1085@end defmac
1086
1087@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1088Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1089provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1090@end defmac
1091
1092@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1093Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1094not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1095@end defmac
1096
1097@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1098If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1099object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1100nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1101on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1102@end defmac
1103
1104@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1105Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1106machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1107structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1108by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1109@end defmac
1110
1111@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1112An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1113alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1114@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1115alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1116field alignment has not been set by the
1117@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1118@end defmac
1119
1120@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1121Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1122to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1123
1124If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1125
1126@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1127@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1128@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1129@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1130@end defmac
1131
1132@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1133Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1134Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1135@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1136the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1137
1138On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1139the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1140a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1141On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1142@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1143@end defmac
1144
1145@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1146If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1147the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1148the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1149macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1150
1151If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1152
1153@findex strcpy
1154One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1155make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1156arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1157constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1158@end defmac
1159
1160@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1161If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1162that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1163@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1164have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1165align the object.
1166
1167If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1168
1169The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1170constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1171constants can be done inline.
1172@end defmac
1173
1174@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1175If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1176the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1177the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1178macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1179
1180If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1181
1182One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1183make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1184@end defmac
1185
1186@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1187If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1188@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1189and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1190have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1191align the slot.
1192
1193If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1194@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1195be used.
1196
1197This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1198of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1199@end defmac
1200
1201@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1202If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1203variable @var{decl}.
1204
1205If this macro is not defined, then
1206@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1207is used.
1208
1209One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1210make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1211@end defmac
1212
1213@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1214If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1215for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1216@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1217
1218If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1219@end defmac
1220
1221@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1222Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1223empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1224
1225If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1226@end defmac
1227
1228@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1229Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1230Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1231
1232If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1233@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1234@end defmac
1235
1236@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1237Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1238if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1239go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1240@end defmac
1241
1242@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1243Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1244alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1245
1246The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1247@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1248structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1249that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1250that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1251
1252Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1253@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1254four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1255not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1256
1257An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1258structure.
1259
1260If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1261a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1262
1263Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1264bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1265support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1266@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1267
1268The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1269@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1270Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1271
1272Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1273@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1274@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1275
1276If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1277bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1278what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1279
1280@smallexample
1281struct foo1
1282@{
1283 char x;
1284 char :0;
1285 char y;
1286@};
1287
1288struct foo2
1289@{
1290 char x;
1291 int :0;
1292 char y;
1293@};
1294
1295main ()
1296@{
1297 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1298 sizeof (struct foo1));
1299 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1300 sizeof (struct foo2));
1301 exit (0);
1302@}
1303@end smallexample
1304
1305If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1306get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1307@end defmac
1308
1309@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1310Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1311to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1312@end defmac
1313
1314@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1315When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1316whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1317structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1318the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1319@end deftypefn
1320
1321@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1322This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1323should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1324these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1325
1326The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1327@end deftypefn
1328
1329@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1330Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1331@code{BLKMODE}.
1332
1333If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1334mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1335case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1336retain the field's mode.
1337
1338Normally, this is not needed.
1339@end defmac
1340
1341@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1342Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1343by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1344way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1345@var{specified}.
1346
1347The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1348the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1349@end defmac
1350
1351@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1352An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1353machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1354this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1355appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1356(DImode)} is assumed.
1357@end defmac
1358
1359@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1360If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1361specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1362@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1363@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1364@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1365having its mode specified.
1366
1367You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1368would most commonly define this macro if the
1369@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
137064-bit mode.
1371@end defmac
1372
1373@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1374If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1375specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1376@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1377
1378You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1379You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1380pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1381@end defmac
1382
1383@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1384This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1385of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1386@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1387targets.
1388@end deftypefn
1389
1390@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1391This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1392of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1393@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1394targets.
1395@end deftypefn
1396
1397@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1398Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1399The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1400@end deftypefn
1401
1402@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1403If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1404mode is towards zero.
1405
1406Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1407floating-point arithmetic.
1408
1409Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1410@end defmac
1411
1412@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1413This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1414bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1415exponent for normal numbers instead.
1416
1417Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1418floating-point arithmetic.
1419
1420The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1421@end defmac
1422
1423@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1424This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1425@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1426Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1427unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1428different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1429alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1430bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1431the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1432(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1433another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1434other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1435
1436When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1437of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1438bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1439and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1440chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1441size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1442alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1443
1444If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1445the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1446used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1447precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1448may affect its placement.
1449@end deftypefn
1450
1451@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1452Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1453@end deftypefn
1454
1455@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1456Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1457@end deftypefn
1458
1459@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1460This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1461to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1462For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1463for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1464registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1465usage.
1466@end deftypefn
1467
1468@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1469This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1470that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1471@end deftypefn
1472
1473@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1474If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1475uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1476to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1477mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1478the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1479not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1480for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1481return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1482string constant.
1483
1484Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1485qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1486fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1487is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1488length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1489ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1490@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1491@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1492code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1493@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1494codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1495spaces in your string.
1496
1497This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1498name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1499can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1500before mangling.
1501
1502The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1503appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1504types.
1505@end deftypefn
1506
1507@node Type Layout
1508@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1509
1510These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1511basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1512the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1513languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1514
1515@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1516A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1517target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1518@end defmac
1519
1520@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1521A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1522target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1523(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1524unit.)
1525@end defmac
1526
1527@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1528A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1529target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1530@end defmac
1531
1532@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1533On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1534@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1535that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1536the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1537value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1538@end defmac
1539
1540@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1541A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1542target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1543words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1544macro must be at least 64.
1545@end defmac
1546
1547@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1548A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1549target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1550@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1551@end defmac
1552
1553@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1554A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1555C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1556this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1557@end defmac
1558
1559@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1560A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1561target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1562@end defmac
1563
1564@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1565A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1566target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1567words.
1568@end defmac
1569
1570@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1571A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1572the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1573words.
1574@end defmac
1575
1576@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1577A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1578the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1579@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1580@end defmac
1581
1582@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1583A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1584the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1585@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1586@end defmac
1587
1588@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1589A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1590the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1591@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1592@end defmac
1593
1594@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1595A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1596the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1597@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1598@end defmac
1599
1600@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1601A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1602the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1603@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1604@end defmac
1605
1606@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1607A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1608the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1609@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1610@end defmac
1611
1612@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1613A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1614the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1615@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1616@end defmac
1617
1618@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1619A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1620the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1621@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1622@end defmac
1623
1624@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1625Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1626if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1627@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1628default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1629@end defmac
1630
1631@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
1632Define this macro if neither @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
1633@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1634@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1635anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1636or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1637otherwise it is 0.
1638@end defmac
1639
1640@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1641Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1642@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1643anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1644is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1645@end defmac
1646
1647@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1648Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1649@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1650anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1651is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1652@end defmac
1653
1654@defmac SF_SIZE
1655@defmacx DF_SIZE
1656@defmacx XF_SIZE
1657@defmacx TF_SIZE
1658Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1659@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1660if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1661@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1662for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1663@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
1664@code{LIBGCC2_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
1665@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1666@end defmac
1667
1668@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1669A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1670assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1671default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1672@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1673@end defmac
1674
1675@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1676A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1677supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1678value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1679If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1680is the default.
1681@end defmac
1682
1683@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1684An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1685@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1686always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1687and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1688@end defmac
1689
1690@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1691This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1692@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1693of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1694@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1695
1696The default is to return false.
1697@end deftypefn
1698
1699@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1700A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1701for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1702contents of the string.
1703
1704The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1705spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1706appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1707of the data type names defined in the function
1708@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1709omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1710crash on startup.
1711
1712If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1713int"}.
1714@end defmac
1715
1716@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1717A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1718for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1719@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1720@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1721
1722If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1723@end defmac
1724
1725@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1726A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1727for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1728the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1729information.
1730
1731If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1732@end defmac
1733
1734@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1735A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1736characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1737@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1738@end defmac
1739
1740@defmac WINT_TYPE
1741A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1742use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1743@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1744contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1745information.
1746
1747If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1748@end defmac
1749
1750@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1751A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1752can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1753The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1754string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1755
1756If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1757@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1758much precision as @code{long long int}.
1759@end defmac
1760
1761@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1762A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1763can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1764type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1765of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1766
1767If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1768@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1769unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1770int}.
1771@end defmac
1772
1773@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1774@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1775@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1776@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1777@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1778@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1779@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1780@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1781@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1782@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1783@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1784@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1785@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1786@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1787@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1788@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1789@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1790@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1791@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1792@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1793@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1794@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1795@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1796@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1797@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1798@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1799@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1800C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1801@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1802@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1803@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1804@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1805@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1806@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1807@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1808@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1809@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1810
1811If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1812type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1813@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1814to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1815these macros are null pointers.
1816@end defmac
1817
1818@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1819The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1820that looks like:
1821
1822@smallexample
1823 struct @{
1824 union @{
1825 void (*fn)();
1826 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1827 @};
1828 ptrdiff_t delta;
1829 @};
1830@end smallexample
1831
1832@noindent
1833The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1834will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1835Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1836always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1837distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1838platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1839that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1840the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1841
1842GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1843this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1844However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1845set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1846bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1847address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1848architecture, you should define this macro to
1849@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1850
1851In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1852in which function addresses are always even, according to
1853@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1854@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1855@end defmac
1856
1857@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1858Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1859macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1860instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1861function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1862data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1863pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1864
1865If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1866of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1867@end defmac
1868
1869@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1870By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1871is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1872the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1873when special alignment is necessary. */
1874@end defmac
1875
1876@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1877There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1878zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1879specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1880of words in each data entry.
1881@end defmac
1882
1883@node Registers
1884@section Register Usage
1885@cindex register usage
1886
1887This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1888has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1889
1890The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1891done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1892on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1893For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1894For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1895
1896@menu
1897* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1898* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1899* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1900* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1901* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1902@end menu
1903
1904@node Register Basics
1905@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1906
1907@c prevent bad page break with this line
1908Registers have various characteristics.
1909
1910@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1911Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1912numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1913pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1914@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1915@end defmac
1916
1917@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1918@cindex fixed register
1919An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1920all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1921general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1922pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1923register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1924machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1925and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1926
1927This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1928commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1929register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1930
1931The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1932the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1933by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1934the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1935@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1936@end defmac
1937
1938@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1939@cindex call-used register
1940@cindex call-clobbered register
1941@cindex call-saved register
1942Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1943clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1944registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1945available for general allocation of values that must live across
1946function calls.
1947
1948If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1949automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1950exit, if the register is used within the function.
1951@end defmac
1952
1953@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1954@cindex call-used register
1955@cindex call-clobbered register
1956@cindex call-saved register
1957Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1958that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1959(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1960This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1961of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1962@end defmac
1963
1964@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1965@cindex call-used register
1966@cindex call-clobbered register
1967@cindex call-saved register
1968A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1969value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1970call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1971macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1972preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1973@end defmac
1974
1975@findex fixed_regs
1976@findex call_used_regs
1977@findex global_regs
1978@findex reg_names
1979@findex reg_class_contents
1980@defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1981Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1982@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1983@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1984any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1985of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1986@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1987@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1988called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1989@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1990from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1991@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1992@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1993@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1994command options have been applied.
1995
1996You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1997
1998@cindex disabling certain registers
1999@cindex controlling register usage
2000If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
2001flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
2002@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
2003registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
2004the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2005to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
2006is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
2007
2008(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
2009of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
2010controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
2011these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
2012@end defmac
2013
2014@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
2015Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2016expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
2017corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
2018function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
2019outbound register.
2020@end defmac
2021
2022@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
2023Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2024expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
2025corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
2026function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
2027register.
2028@end defmac
2029
2030@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
2031Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2032expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
2033register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
2034need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
2035gotos.
2036@end defmac
2037
2038@defmac PC_REGNUM
2039If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2040register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2041@end defmac
2042
2043@node Allocation Order
2044@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2045@cindex order of register allocation
2046@cindex register allocation order
2047
2048@c prevent bad page break with this line
2049Registers are allocated in order.
2050
2051@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2052If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2053numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2054to use them (from most preferred to least).
2055
2056If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2057(all else being equal).
2058
2059One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2060registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2061instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2062machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2063the highest numbered allocable register first.
2064@end defmac
2065
2066@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2067A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2068hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2069
2070Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2071Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2072register; and so on.
2073
2074The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2075@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2076
2077On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2078@end defmac
2079
2080@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2081Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2082prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2083using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2084allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2085call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2086should be defined.
2087@end defmac
2088
2089@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2090In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2091Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2092If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2093based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2094be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2095value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2096to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2097
2098On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2099@end defmac
2100
2101@node Values in Registers
2102@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2103
2104This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2105(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2106consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2107
2108@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2109A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2110at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2111@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2112cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2113and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2114
2115On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2116definition of this macro is
2117
2118@smallexample
2119#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2120 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2121 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2122@end smallexample
2123@end defmac
2124
2125@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2126A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2127in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2128in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2129multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2130this mode by the number of registers returned by
2131@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2132
2133For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2134registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2135nonzero.
2136
2137This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2138@code{subreg_get_info}
2139would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2140represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2141@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2142registers and so not be representable.
2143@end defmac
2144
2145@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2146For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2147@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2148returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2149including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2150@end defmac
2151
2152@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2153Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2154of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2155should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2156used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2157happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2158floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2159@end defmac
2160
2161@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2162A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2163of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2164registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2165are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2166
2167@smallexample
2168#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2169@end smallexample
2170
2171You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2172because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2173
2174@cindex register pairs
2175On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2176register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2177odd register numbers for such modes.
2178
2179The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2180@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2181register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2182value into the register and back out not alter it.
2183
2184Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2185all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2186@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2187you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2188is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2189and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2190to be tieable.
2191
2192Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2193Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2194in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2195can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2196mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2197registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2198
2199On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2200modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2201registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2202non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2203@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2204floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2205normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2206unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2207register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2208
2209The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2210they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2211instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2212@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2213constraints for those instructions.
2214
2215On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2216so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2217register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2218floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2219be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2220@end defmac
2221
2222@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2223A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2224@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2225
2226One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2227another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2228handler.
2229
2230The default is always nonzero.
2231@end defmac
2232
2233@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2234A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2235@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2236
2237If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2238@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2239any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2240should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2241this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2242accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2243
2244You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2245possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2246allocation.
2247@end defmac
2248
2249@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2250This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2251@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2252
2253One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2254is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2255
2256The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2257@end deftypefn
2258
2259@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2260Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2261registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2262@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2263@end defmac
2264
2265@node Leaf Functions
2266@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2267
2268@cindex leaf functions
2269@cindex functions, leaf
2270On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2271more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2272means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2273are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2274normally arrive.
2275
2276The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2277other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2278registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2279function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2280handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2281functions''.
2282
2283GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2284suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2285registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2286accomplish this.
2287
2288@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2289Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2290contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2291function treatment.
2292
2293If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2294registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2295GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2296used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2297in this vector.
2298
2299Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2300the treatment of leaf functions.
2301@end defmac
2302
2303@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2304A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2305should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2306
2307If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2308function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2309will cause the compiler to abort.
2310
2311Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2312treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2313this.
2314@end defmac
2315
2316@findex current_function_is_leaf
2317@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2318@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2319@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2320specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2321which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2322set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2323compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2324@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2325functions which only use leaf registers.
2326@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2327that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2328@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2329@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2330@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2331
2332@node Stack Registers
2333@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2334
2335There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2336``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2337pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2338stack.
2339
2340Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2341they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2342support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2343point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2344stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2345@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2346with it, as well as defining these macros.
2347
2348@defmac STACK_REGS
2349Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2350@end defmac
2351
2352@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2353This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2354the machine has any stack-like registers.
2355@end defmac
2356
2357@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2358The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2359of the stack.
2360@end defmac
2361
2362@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2363The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2364the stack.
2365@end defmac
2366
2367@node Register Classes
2368@section Register Classes
2369@cindex register class definitions
2370@cindex class definitions, register
2371
2372On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2373For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2374certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2375restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2376
2377You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2378which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2379that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2380
2381@findex ALL_REGS
2382@findex NO_REGS
2383In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2384class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2385class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2386union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2387
2388@findex GENERAL_REGS
2389One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2390terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2391@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2392the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2393to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2394
2395Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2396then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2397
2398The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2399constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2400You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2401them in operand constraints.
2402
2403You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2404instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2405either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2406certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2407which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2408
2409You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2410classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2411contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2412in their union.
2413
2414When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2415certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2416Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2417a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2418specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2419
2420Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2421instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2422each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2423mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2424single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2425this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2426instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2427single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2428@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2429
2430@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2431An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2432as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2433must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2434@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2435tells how many classes there are.
2436
2437Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2438the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2439in many of the tables described below.
2440@end deftp
2441
2442@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2443The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2444
2445@smallexample
2446#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2447@end smallexample
2448@end defmac
2449
2450@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2451An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2452constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2453@end defmac
2454
2455@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2456An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2457which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2458@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2459register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2460
2461When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2462Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2463several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2464for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2465In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2466registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2467so on.
2468@end defmac
2469
2470@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2471A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2472@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2473which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2474register.
2475@end defmac
2476
2477@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2478A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2479base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2480which is the register value plus a displacement.
2481@end defmac
2482
2483@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2484This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2485the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2486@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2487@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2488@end defmac
2489
2490@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2491A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2492base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2493register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2494addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2495@end defmac
2496
2497@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2498A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2499base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2500context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2501the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2502address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2503@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2504index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2505@end defmac
2506
2507@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2508A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2509index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2510address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2511added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2512@end defmac
2513
2514@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2515A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2516suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2517Like @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}, this macro should also
2518define a strict and a non-strict variant. Both variants behave
2519the same for hard register; for pseudos, the strict variant will
2520pass only those that have been allocated to a valid hard registers,
2521while the non-strict variant will pass all pseudos.
2522
2523@findex REG_OK_STRICT
2524Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this and
2525other macros define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
2526@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
2527that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
2528@end defmac
2529
2530@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2531A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2532that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2533@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2534reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2535you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2536@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2537addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2538@code{address_operand}.
2539
2540This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2541@end defmac
2542
2543@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2544A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2545use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2546memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2547pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2548define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2549than other base register uses.
2550
2551Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2552@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2553
2554This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2555@end defmac
2556
2557@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2558A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2559that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2560appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2561immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2562address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2563@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2564corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2565@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2566that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2567
2568This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2569@end defmac
2570
2571@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2572A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2573suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2574either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2575allocated such a hard register.
2576
2577The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2578the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2579two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2580labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2581labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2582may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2583looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2584only if neither labeling works.
2585
2586This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2587@end defmac
2588
2589@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2590A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2591to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2592@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2593another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2594safe:
2595
2596@smallexample
2597#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2598@end smallexample
2599
2600Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2601example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2602for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2603@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2604Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2605
2606One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2607@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2608loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2609force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2610immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2611instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2612register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2613@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2614into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2615@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2616of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2617
2618If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2619through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2620to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2621reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2622this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2623the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2624@end defmac
2625
2626@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2627Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2628input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2629@var{class}, unchanged.
2630
2631You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2632reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2633@end defmac
2634
2635@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2636A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2637to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2638@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2639ordinarily be used.
2640
2641Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2642there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2643
2644The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2645smaller class.
2646
2647Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2648require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2649@end defmac
2650
2651@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2652Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2653from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2654@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2655from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2656term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2657directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2658register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2659destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2660source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2661reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2662and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2663intermediate register still holds the required value.
2664
2665Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2666allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2667register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2668address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2669when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2670as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2671that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2672describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2673these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2674of the scratch register(s).
2675
2676In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2677
2678For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2679and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2680@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2681hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2682needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2683
2684If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2685an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2686return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2687If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2688If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2689that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2690
2691If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2692perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2693closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2694required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2695copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2696
2697You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2698in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2699and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2700for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2701single-register-class
2702@c [later: or memory]
2703output constraint.
2704
2705When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2706hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2707register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2708have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2709
2710@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2711@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2712@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2713@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2714@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2715@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2716@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2717@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2718
2719
2720@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2721pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2722Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2723in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2724
2725Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2726currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2727to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2728
2729@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2730copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2731(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2732Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2733of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2734forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2735@end deftypefn
2736
2737@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2738@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2739@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2740These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2741@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2742
2743These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2744target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2745reload phase that it may
2746need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2747register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2748register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2749you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2750largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2751intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2752
2753If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2754intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2755was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2756class required. If the
2757requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2758@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2759macros identically.
2760
2761The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2762Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2763can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2764@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2765macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2766
2767If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2768intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2769@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2770(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2771implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2772@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2773register.
2774
2775These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2776register that
2777contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2778class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2779value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2780register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2781Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2782
2783@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2784pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2785Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2786in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2787
2788These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2789registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2790registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2791would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2792the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2793intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2794general registers.
2795@end defmac
2796
2797@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2798Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2799to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2800those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2801@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2802class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2803and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2804
2805Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2806@end defmac
2807
2808@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2809Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2810allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2811If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2812defined by this macro.
2813
2814Do not define this macro if you do not define
2815@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2816@end defmac
2817
2818@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2819When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2820registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2821hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2822load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2823same as that of @var{mode}.
2824
2825This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2826bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2827in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2828registers.
2829
2830However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2831the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2832differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2833widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2834suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2835details.
2836
2837Do not define this macro if you do not define
2838@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2839is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2840@end defmac
2841
2842@defmac CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2843A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2844to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2845registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2846
2847The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2848register and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be
2849used. Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2850allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2851registers were needed for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero
2852for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2853@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2854register. If there would not be another register available for
2855reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2856the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2857allocation.
2858@end defmac
2859
2860@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2861A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2862of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2863
2864This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2865the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2866should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2867@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2868
2869This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2870in the reload pass.
2871@end defmac
2872
2873@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2874If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2875a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2876
2877For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2878floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2879Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2880does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2881register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2882as below:
2883
2884@smallexample
2885#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2886 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2887 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2888@end smallexample
2889@end defmac
2890
2891@hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2892Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2893(@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2894classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2895purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2896possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2897The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2898
2899The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2900have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2901the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2902
2903This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2904options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2905@code{target_reinit}.
2906
2907The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2908otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2909macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2910allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2911the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2912@end deftypefn
2913
2914@defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2915See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2916@end defmac
2917
2918@node Old Constraints
2919@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2920@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2921@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2922
2923Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2924of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2925Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2926it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2927
2928@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2929For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2930@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2931constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2932you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2933constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2934DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2935to handle specially.
2936There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2937for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2938transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2939return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2940will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2941@end defmac
2942
2943@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2944A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2945letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2946value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2947the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2948corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2949to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2950@end defmac
2951
2952@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2953Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2954passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2955different variants.
2956@end defmac
2957
2958@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2959A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2960letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2961particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2962letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2963the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2964not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2965@var{value}.
2966@end defmac
2967
2968@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2969Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2970string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2971between different variants.
2972@end defmac
2973
2974@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2975A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2976letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2977(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2978
2979If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2980@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2981range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2982letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2983
2984@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2985@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2986or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2987between these kinds.
2988@end defmac
2989
2990@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2991Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2992string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2993between different variants.
2994@end defmac
2995
2996@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2997A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2998letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2999memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
3000elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
3001@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
3002may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
3003
3004If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
3005if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3006constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
3007constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3008
3009For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3010in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3011letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3012@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3013a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3014alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3015does not include r0 on the output.
3016@end defmac
3017
3018@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3019Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3020in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3021variants.
3022@end defmac
3023
3024@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3025A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3026letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3027be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3028
3029It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3030at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3031comprises a subset of all memory references including
3032all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3033pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3034type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3035
3036For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3037memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3038register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3039@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3040If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3041a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3042reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3043into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3044an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3045@end defmac
3046
3047@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3048A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3049letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3050@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3051be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3052
3053It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3054at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3055a subset of all memory addresses including
3056all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3057pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3058type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3059
3060Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3061be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3062analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3063@end defmac
3064
3065@node Stack and Calling
3066@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3067@cindex calling conventions
3068
3069@c prevent bad page break with this line
3070This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3071
3072@menu
3073* Frame Layout::
3074* Exception Handling::
3075* Stack Checking::
3076* Frame Registers::
3077* Elimination::
3078* Stack Arguments::
3079* Register Arguments::
3080* Scalar Return::
3081* Aggregate Return::
3082* Caller Saves::
3083* Function Entry::
3084* Profiling::
3085* Tail Calls::
3086* Stack Smashing Protection::
3087@end menu
3088
3089@node Frame Layout
3090@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3091@cindex stack frame layout
3092@cindex frame layout
3093
3094@c prevent bad page break with this line
3095Here is the basic stack layout.
3096
3097@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3098Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3099pointer to a smaller address.
3100
3101When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3102compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3103definition used does not matter.
3104@end defmac
3105
3106@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3107This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3108on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3109@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3110
3111The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3112and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3113the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3114to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3115space for the next item on the stack.
3116
3117The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3118defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3119which is often wrong.
3120@end defmac
3121
3122@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3123Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3124are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3125@end defmac
3126
3127@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3128Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3129addresses on the stack.
3130@end defmac
3131
3132@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3133Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3134
3135If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3136subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3137Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3138value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3139@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3140@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3141@end defmac
3142
3143@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3144Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3145The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3146
3147On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3148is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3149alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3150stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3151@end defmac
3152
3153@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3154Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3155outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3156zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3157
3158If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3159the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3160@end defmac
3161
3162@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3163Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3164address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3165function.
3166
3167If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3168the first argument's address.
3169@end defmac
3170
3171@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3172Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3173on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3174
3175The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3176length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3177machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3178@end defmac
3179
3180@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3181A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3182stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3183@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3184default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3185elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3186@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3187@end defmac
3188
3189@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3190A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3191frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3192@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3193itself.
3194
3195If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3196of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3197address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3198@end defmac
3199
3200@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3201If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3202setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3203on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3204before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3205define this macro.
3206@end defmac
3207
3208@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3209This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3210the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3211The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3212machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3213@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3214@end deftypefn
3215
3216@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3217A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3218address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3219of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3220You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3221as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3222@end defmac
3223
3224@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3225A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3226address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3227the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3228frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3229@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3230
3231The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3232@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3233determine the return address of other frames.
3234@end defmac
3235
3236@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3237Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3238from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3239@end defmac
3240
3241@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3242A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3243incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3244prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3245value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3246the stack.
3247
3248You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3249debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3250
3251If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3252@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3253@end defmac
3254
3255@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3256A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3257number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3258must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3259be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3260
3261This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3262general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3263frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3264over time.
3265@end defmac
3266
3267@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3268A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3269number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3270only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3271someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3272terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3273@end defmac
3274
3275@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3276This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3277contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3278info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3279@smallexample
3280(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3281@end smallexample
3282and
3283@smallexample
3284(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3285@end smallexample
3286to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3287the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3288the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3289@end deftypefn
3290
3291@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3292A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3293from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3294frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3295the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3296previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3297
3298You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3299debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3300@end defmac
3301
3302@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3303A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3304from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3305final value should coincide with that calculated by
3306@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3307during virtual register instantiation.
3308
3309The default value for this macro is
3310@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3311which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3312immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3313some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3314and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3315
3316You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3317want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3318DWARF 2.
3319@end defmac
3320
3321@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3322If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3323in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3324The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3325@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3326
3327Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3328via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3329variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3330defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3331based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3332of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3333should be defined.
3334@end defmac
3335
3336@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3337If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3338in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3339in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3340may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3341@end defmac
3342
3343@node Exception Handling
3344@subsection Exception Handling Support
3345@cindex exception handling
3346
3347@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3348A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3349data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3350@var{N} registers are usable.
3351
3352The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3353handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3354should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3355but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33562 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3357
3358You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3359handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3360@end defmac
3361
3362@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3363A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3364to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3365This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3366It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3367
3368Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3369untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3370
3371Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3372by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3373this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3374stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3375this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3376that provided by DWARF 2.
3377@end defmac
3378
3379@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3380A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3381to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3382return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3383
3384Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3385return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3386address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3387the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3388frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3389been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3390target call frame.
3391
3392Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3393address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3394the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3395
3396If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3397define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3398@end defmac
3399
3400@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3401If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3402to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3403exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3404using it to return to the exception handler.
3405@end defmac
3406
3407@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3408This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3409handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3410that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3411and so may be read-only.
3412
3413@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3414@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3415The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3416as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3417
3418If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3419represented directly.
3420@end defmac
3421
3422@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3423This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3424to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3425Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3426be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3427
3428This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3429handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3430of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3431to be emitted.
3432@end defmac
3433
3434@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3435A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3436so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3437@end defmac
3438
3439@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3440This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3441code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3442available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3443through signal frames.
3444
3445This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3446@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3447@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3448@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3449for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3450the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3451save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3452evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3453the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3454
3455For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3456@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3457@end defmac
3458
3459@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3460This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3461call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3462usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3463
3464This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3465@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3466@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3467for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3468@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3469be updated in @var{fs}.
3470@end defmac
3471
3472@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3473A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3474info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3475linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3476@end defmac
3477
3478@node Stack Checking
3479@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3480
3481GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3482stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3483three ways:
3484
3485@enumerate
3486@item
3487If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3488will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3489at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3490other special processing.
3491
3492@item
3493If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3494@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3495that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3496static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3497in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3498stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3499approach below.
3500
3501@item
3502If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3503``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3504@end enumerate
3505
3506If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3507GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3508@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3509dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3510
3511@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3512A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3513machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3514is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3515checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3516value of this macro is zero.
3517@end defmac
3518
3519@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3520A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3521in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3522like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3523approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3524@end defmac
3525
3526@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3527An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3528instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3529define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3530the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3531of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3532@end defmac
3533
3534@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3535An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3536when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3537contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3538thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3539is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3540default value of this macro is zero.
3541@end defmac
3542
3543@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3544The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3545languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3546with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35478192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3548most machines.
3549@end defmac
3550
3551The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3552nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3553in the opposite case.
3554
3555@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3556The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3557instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3558stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3559checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3560default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3561systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3562@end defmac
3563
3564@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3565GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3566represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3567space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3568You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3569use the default of four words.
3570@end defmac
3571
3572@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3573The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3574fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3575@option{-fstack-check}.
3576GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3577normally not need to override that default.
3578@end defmac
3579
3580@need 2000
3581@node Frame Registers
3582@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3583
3584@c prevent bad page break with this line
3585This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3586
3587@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3588The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3589fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3590the hardware determines which register this is.
3591@end defmac
3592
3593@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3594The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3595access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3596hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3597choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3598@end defmac
3599
3600@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3601On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3602offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3603allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3604between these two locations). On those machines, define
3605@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3606be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3607@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3608used for the frame pointer.
3609
3610You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3611is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3612the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3613completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3614definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3615@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3616or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3617
3618Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3619@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3620@end defmac
3621
3622@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3623The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3624the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3625frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3626register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3627wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3628pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3629@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3630(@pxref{Elimination}).
3631@end defmac
3632
3633@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3634The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3635access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3636machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3637pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3638to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3639@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3640
3641Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3642address from the stack.
3643@end defmac
3644
3645@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3646@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3647Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3648register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3649function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3650number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3651these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3652not be defined.
3653
3654The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3655
3656If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3657defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3658@end defmac
3659
3660@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3661This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3662targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3663nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3664attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3665those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3666
3667The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3668
3669If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3670provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3671Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3672from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3673will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3674@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3675@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3676@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3677The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3678@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3679to refer to those items.
3680@end deftypefn
3681
3682@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3683This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3684saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3685DWARF2 exception handling.
3686
3687Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3688exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3689extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3690in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3691used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3692routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3693registers that are not call-saved.
3694
3695If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3696@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3697@end defmac
3698
3699@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3700
3701This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3702for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3703
3704If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3705@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3706@end defmac
3707
3708@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3709
3710Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3711is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3712Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3713column number to use instead.
3714
3715See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3716@end defmac
3717
3718@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3719
3720Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3721used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3722debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3723should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3724@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3725
3726@end defmac
3727
3728@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3729
3730Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3731that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3732should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3733.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3734return @code{@var{regno}}.
3735
3736@end defmac
3737
3738@node Elimination
3739@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3740
3741@c prevent bad page break with this line
3742This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3743
3744@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3745This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3746a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3747value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3748
3749This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3750according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3751constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3752to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3753Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3754pointer.
3755
3756In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3757without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3758automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3759@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3760them.
3761
3762In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3763register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3764fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3765
3766Default return value is @code{false}.
3767@end deftypefn
3768
3769@findex get_frame_size
3770@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3771A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3772between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3773the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3774such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3775registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3776
3777If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3778need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3779@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3780case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3781@end defmac
3782
3783@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3784If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3785eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3786defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3787references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3788
3789The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3790of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3791
3792On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3793the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3794must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3795replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3796depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3797
3798In this case, you might specify:
3799@smallexample
3800#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3801@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3802 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3803 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3804@end smallexample
3805
3806Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3807specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3808@end defmac
3809
3810@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3811This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3812try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3813@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3814is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3815preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3816knows about.
3817
3818Default return value is @code{true}.
3819@end deftypefn
3820
3821@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3822This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3823specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3824registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3825defined.
3826@end defmac
3827
3828@node Stack Arguments
3829@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3830@cindex arguments on stack
3831@cindex stack arguments
3832
3833The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3834on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3835control passing certain arguments in registers.
3836
3837@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3838This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3839prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3840passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3841cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3842The default is to not promote prototypes.
3843@end deftypefn
3844
3845@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3846A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3847outgoing arguments.
3848If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3849That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3850allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3851it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3852@end defmac
3853
3854@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3855A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3856last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3857defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3858and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3859@end defmac
3860
3861@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3862A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3863stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3864
3865On some machines, the definition
3866
3867@smallexample
3868#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3869@end smallexample
3870
3871@noindent
3872will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3873to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3874alignment. Then the definition should be
3875
3876@smallexample
3877#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3878@end smallexample
3879@end defmac
3880
3881@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3882@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3883A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3884will be computed and placed into the variable
3885@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3886onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3887increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3888
3889Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3890is not proper.
3891@end defmac
3892
3893@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3894Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3895allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3896registers.
3897
3898The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3899arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3900which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3901The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3902of the function.
3903
3904This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3905machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3906which.
3907@end defmac
3908@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3909@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3910
3911@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3912Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3913caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3914when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3915if the function called is a library function.
3916
3917If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3918whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3919@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3920@end defmac
3921
3922@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3923Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3924stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3925@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3926@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3927
3928Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3929stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3930suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3931stack in its natural location.
3932@end defmac
3933
3934@deftypefn {Target Hook} TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3935This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3936a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3937and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3938
3939@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3940the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3941@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3942From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3943
3944@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3945describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3946@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3947From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3948arguments (if known).
3949
3950When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3951will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3952you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3953by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3954a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3955in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3956
3957@var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3958stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3959argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3960
3961On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3962of this macro is @var{stack-size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3963calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3964the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3965convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3966arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3967nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3968@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3969number of arguments.
3970@end deftypefn
3971
3972@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3973A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3974pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3975when compiling a function call.
3976
3977@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3978have been accumulated.
3979
3980On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3981that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3982that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3983call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3984appropriate.
3985@end defmac
3986
3987@node Register Arguments
3988@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3989@cindex arguments in registers
3990@cindex registers arguments
3991
3992This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3993types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3994the stack.
3995
3996@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3997A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3998in a register, and which register.
3999
4000The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
4001arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4002the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4003(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4004which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
4005correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
4006@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
4007occurred.
4008
4009The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
4010hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
4011argument on the stack.
4012
4013For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
4014pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
4015
4016The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4017used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4018@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4019@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4020describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4021@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4022register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4023register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4024second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4025the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4026As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4027RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4028argument is also stored on the stack.
4029
4030The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4031VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4032pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4033
4034@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4035The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4036where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4037nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4038by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4039
4040@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4041@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4042You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4043in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4044type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4045is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4046argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4047defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4048a register.
4049@end defmac
4050
4051@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4052This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4053solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4054definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4055documentation.
4056@end deftypefn
4057
4058@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4059Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4060that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4061necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4062argument.
4063
4064For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4065the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4066be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4067where the arguments will arrive.
4068
4069If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4070serves both purposes.
4071@end defmac
4072
4073@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4074This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4075argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4076arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4077pushed on the stack.
4078
4079On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4080registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4081first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4082on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4083structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4084in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4085compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4086
4087@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4088register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4089@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4090@end deftypefn
4091
4092@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *@var{cum}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4093This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4094position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4095predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4096passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4097
4098If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4099pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4100The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4101to that type.
4102@end deftypefn
4103
4104@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4105The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4106known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4107function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4108by the caller.
4109
4110For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4111determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4112not be generated.
4113
4114The default version of this hook always returns false.
4115@end deftypefn
4116
4117@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4118A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4119@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4120the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4121argument so far.
4122
4123There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4124arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4125variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4126arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4127@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4128should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4129@end defmac
4130
4131@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4132If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4133function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4134created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4135reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4136If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4137@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4138@end defmac
4139
4140@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4141A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4142@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4143variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4144is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4145the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4146For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4147declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4148@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4149being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4150arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4151parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4152@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4153
4154When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4155@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4156contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4157an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4158macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4159never both of them at once.
4160@end defmac
4161
4162@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4163Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4164it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4165@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4166is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41670)} is used instead.
4168@end defmac
4169
4170@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4171Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4172finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4173undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4174
4175The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4176with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4177argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4178@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4179@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4180@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4181@end defmac
4182
4183@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4184A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4185@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4186values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4187Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4188the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4189
4190This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4191on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4192used for arguments without any special help.
4193@end defmac
4194
4195@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4196If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4197offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4198which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4199slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4200top.
4201@end defmac
4202
4203@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4204If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4205to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4206@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4207@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4208
4209The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4210multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
4211it.
4212
4213This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4214For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4215big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4216constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4217@end defmac
4218
4219@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4220If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4221implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4222next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4223controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4224arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4225@end defmac
4226
4227@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4228Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4229memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4230macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4231machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4232@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4233registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4234a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4235required.
4236@end defmac
4237
4238@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4239If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
4240of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
4241@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
4242@end defmac
4243
4244@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4245A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4246register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4247@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4248the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4249used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4250stack.
4251@end defmac
4252
4253@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4254This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4255as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4256arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4257to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4258AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4259registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4260point register.
4261
4262The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4263false.
4264@end deftypefn
4265
4266@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4267This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4268The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4269@end deftypefn
4270
4271@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char ** @var{pname}, tree @var{ptype})
4272This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4273to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4274variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4275to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptype} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4276variable.
4277The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptype} are used to store the result of
4278this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4279internal type.
4280If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4281Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4282macro to iterate through all types.
4283@end deftypefn
4284
4285@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4286This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4287@var{fndecl}.
4288The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4289@end deftypefn
4290
4291@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4292This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4293type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4294@code{NULL_TREE}.
4295@end deftypefn
4296
4297@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4298This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4299@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4300arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4301@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4302@end deftypefn
4303
4304@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4305Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4306with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4307hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4308@end deftypefn
4309
4310@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4311Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4312insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4313considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4314must work.
4315
4316The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4317required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4318Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4319code in @file{optabs.c}.
4320@end deftypefn
4321
4322@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4323Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4324insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4325must have move patterns for this mode.
4326@end deftypefn
4327
4328@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4329Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4330small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4331@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4332in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4333In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4334for any mode.
4335
4336On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4337insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4338to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4339if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4340insn.
4341
4342Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4343in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4344the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4345classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4346registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4347registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4348SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4349strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4350machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4351
4352The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4353safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4354unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4355that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4356to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4357of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4358@end deftypefn
4359
4360@node Scalar Return
4361@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4362@cindex return values in registers
4363@cindex values, returned by functions
4364@cindex scalars, returned as values
4365
4366This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4367values---values that can fit in registers.
4368
4369@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4370
4371Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4372returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4373representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4374representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4375function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4376compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4377Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4378a function returns a value.
4379
4380On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4381(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4382place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4383@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4384The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4385multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4386@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4387location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4388the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4389that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4390port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4391@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4392
4393If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4394the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4395@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4396
4397If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4398node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4399pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4400convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4401known.
4402
4403Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4404which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4405the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4406different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4407
4408@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4409aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4410@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4411@end deftypefn
4412
4413@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4414This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4415a new target instead.
4416@end defmac
4417
4418@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4419A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4420function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4421
4422Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4423support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4424specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4425compiled.
4426@end defmac
4427
4428@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4429Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4430function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4431
4432The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4433library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4434representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4435
4436If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4437@end deftypefn
4438
4439@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4440A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4441register in which the values of called function may come back.
4442
4443A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4444second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4445recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4446suffices:
4447
4448@smallexample
4449#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4450@end smallexample
4451
4452If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4453function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4454should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4455
4456This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4457for a new target instead.
4458@end defmac
4459
4460@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4461A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4462register in which the values of called function may come back.
4463
4464A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4465second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4466recognized by this target hook.
4467
4468If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4469function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4470should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4471
4472If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4473@end deftypefn
4474
4475@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4476Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4477need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4478saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4479@end defmac
4480
4481@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4482This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4483at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4484padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4485is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4486
4487Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4488be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4489or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44904-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4491@code{SImode} rtx.
4492@end deftypefn
4493
4494@node Aggregate Return
4495@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4496@cindex aggregates as return values
4497@cindex large return values
4498@cindex returning aggregate values
4499@cindex structure value address
4500
4501When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4502cases), the value is not returned according to
4503@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4504caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4505should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4506address}.
4507
4508This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4509memory.
4510
4511@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4512This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4513function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4514Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4515will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4516libcalls.
4517
4518Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4519by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4520takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4521possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4522definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4523values, and 0 otherwise.
4524
4525Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4526be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4527to indicate this.
4528@end deftypefn
4529
4530@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4531Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4532in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4533only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4534If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4535and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4536target hook.
4537
4538If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4539@end defmac
4540
4541@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4542This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4543address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4544passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4545be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4546hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4547argument.
4548
4549On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4550is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4551caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4552be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4553@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4554the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4555the caller.
4556
4557If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4558stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4559@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4560structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4561to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4562@end deftypefn
4563
4564@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4565Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4566for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4567the address of a static variable containing the value.
4568
4569Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4570pass an address to the subroutine.
4571
4572This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4573nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4574@end defmac
4575
4576@node Caller Saves
4577@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4578
4579If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4580makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4581must live across calls.
4582
4583@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4584A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4585a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4586restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4587this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4588
4589If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4590machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4591@end defmac
4592
4593@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4594A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4595of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4596@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4597returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4598will select the smallest suitable mode.
4599@end defmac
4600
4601@node Function Entry
4602@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4603@cindex function entry and exit
4604@cindex prologue
4605@cindex epilogue
4606
4607This section describes the macros that output function entry
4608(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4609
4610@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4611If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4612function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4613initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4614saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4615local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4616stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4617
4618The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4619macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4620
4621@findex regs_ever_live
4622To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4623@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4624@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4625prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4626call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4627@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4628
4629On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4630not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4631they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4632appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4633registers are used in the function.
4634
4635@findex frame_pointer_needed
4636On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4637function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4638pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4639frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4640@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4641time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4642
4643The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4644required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4645listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4646order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4647stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4648the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4649for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4650compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4651or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4652need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4653@end deftypefn
4654
4655@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4656If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4657prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4658emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4659emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4660@end deftypefn
4661
4662@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4663If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4664epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4665emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4666emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4667@end deftypefn
4668
4669@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4670If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4671function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4672registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4673called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4674same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4675registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4676@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4677
4678On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4679of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4680instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4681@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4682
4683Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4684@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4685switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4686define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4687target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4688condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4689
4690On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4691function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4692two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4693is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4694@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4695a function that needs a frame pointer.
4696
4697Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4698@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4699The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4700function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4701
4702On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4703others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4704given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4705number of arguments.
4706
4707@findex current_function_pops_args
4708Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4709functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4710needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4711function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4712@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4713@end deftypefn
4714
4715@itemize @bullet
4716@item
4717@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4718A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4719uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4720stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4721if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4722arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4723yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4724region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4725registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4726features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4727
4728@item
4729An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4730The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4731the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4732machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4733in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4734a save area.
4735
4736@item
4737A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4738boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4739this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4740save area closer to the top of the stack.
4741
4742@item
4743@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4744Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4745@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4746argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4747@end itemize
4748
4749@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4750Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4751instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4752pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4753adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4754default is 0.
4755
4756Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4757frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4758stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4759compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4760@end defmac
4761
4762@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4763Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4764used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4765pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4766@end defmac
4767
4768@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4769Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4770used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4771on entry to an exception edge.
4772@end defmac
4773
4774@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4775Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4776instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4777definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4778representing the number of delay slots there.
4779@end defmac
4780
4781@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4782A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4783slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4784
4785The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4786being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4787eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4788of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4789If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4790may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4791(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4792slot.
4793
4794@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4795@findex final_scan_insn
4796The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4797list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4798@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4799delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4800@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4801outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4802@code{final_scan_insn}.
4803
4804You need not define this macro if you did not define
4805@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4806@end defmac
4807
4808@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4809A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4810function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4811inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4812adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4813the real function.
4814
4815First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4816contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4817contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4818in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4819e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4820all other incoming arguments.
4821
4822Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4823made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4824adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4825
4826@smallexample
4827p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4828@end smallexample
4829
4830After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4831@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4832not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4833return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4834
4835The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4836the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4837of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4838and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4839
4840The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4841have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4842some targets, but probably not.
4843
4844If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4845front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4846@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4847not support varargs.
4848@end deftypefn
4849
4850@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4851A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4852to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4853arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4854generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4855previously exposed.
4856@end deftypefn
4857
4858@node Profiling
4859@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4860@cindex profiling, code generation
4861
4862These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4863
4864@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4865A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4866assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4867
4868@findex mcount
4869The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4870your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4871compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4872compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4873
4874Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4875variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4876@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4877the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4878@end defmac
4879
4880@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4881A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4882code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4883not support profiling.
4884@end defmac
4885
4886@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4887Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4888@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4889allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4890implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4891@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4892@end defmac
4893
4894@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4895Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4896the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4897@end defmac
4898
4899@node Tail Calls
4900@subsection Permitting tail calls
4901@cindex tail calls
4902
4903@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4904True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4905call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4906or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4907
4908It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4909tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4910during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4911as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4912``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4913may vary greatly between different architectures.
4914@end deftypefn
4915
4916@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4917Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4918function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4919cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4920registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4921TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4922FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4923@end deftypefn
4924
4925@node Stack Smashing Protection
4926@subsection Stack smashing protection
4927@cindex stack smashing protection
4928
4929@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4930This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4931for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4932runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4933that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4934variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4935
4936The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4937@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4938@end deftypefn
4939
4940@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4941This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4942stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4943involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4944
4945The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4946@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4947normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4948@end deftypefn
4949
4950@node Varargs
4951@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4952@cindex varargs implementation
4953
4954GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4955@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4956on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4957varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4958conditionals to include it.
4959
4960ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4961the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4962implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4963to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4964@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4965supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4966
4967However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4968the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4969below.
4970
4971@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4972Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4973that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4974versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4975you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4976
4977On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4978control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4979other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4980found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4981
4982Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4983beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4984@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4985This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4986to use them for its own purposes.
4987@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4988@c 10feb93
4989@end defmac
4990
4991@defmac __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4992Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4993registers.
4994
4995In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4996arguments, each for a particular category of data types. (For example,
4997on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4998arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4999To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
5000have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
5001registers in each category have been used so far
5002
5003@code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
5004@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
5005with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access. Thus, the
5006value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
5007
5008Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
5009of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
5010value in the @code{va_list} object. This is because @code{va_list} will
5011have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
5012values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
5013@end defmac
5014
5015@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5016This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
5017arguments. It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5018argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5019returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5020argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5021fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5022verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5023of the current function.
5024@end defmac
5025
5026@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5027Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5028passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5029has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5030specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5031with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5032
5033@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5034considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5035kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5036
5037The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5038interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5039@end defmac
5040
5041These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5042
5043@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5044If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5045@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5046beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5047return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5048to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5049@end deftypefn
5050
5051@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5052This target hook offers an alternative to using
5053@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5054@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5055register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5056have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5057use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5058pass all their arguments on the stack.
5059
5060The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5061structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5062named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5063last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5064
5065The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5066argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5067store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5068variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5069store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5070frame.
5071
5072Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5073compile time without knowing their data types,
5074@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5075have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5076for all data types.
5077
5078If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5079arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5080happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5081end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5082not generate any instructions in this case.
5083@end deftypefn
5084
5085@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5086Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5087argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5088
5089This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5090is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5091@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5092arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5093but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5094then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5095except the last are treated as named.
5096
5097You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5098@end deftypefn
5099
5100@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5101If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5102@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5103@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5104defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5105@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5106Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5107@end deftypefn
5108
5109@node Trampolines
5110@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5111@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5112@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5113
5114A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5115when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5116the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5117tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5118trampoline.
5119
5120The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5121address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5122the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5123two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5124exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5125machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5126two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5127operands.
5128
5129The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5130parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5131immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5132simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5133proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5134may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5135separately.
5136
5137@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5138This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5139on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5140the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5141label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5142
5143If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5144for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5145code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5146to generate it on the spot.
5147@end deftypefn
5148
5149@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5150Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5151(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5152@end defmac
5153
5154@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5155A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5156@end defmac
5157
5158@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5159Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5160
5161If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5162is used for aligning trampolines.
5163@end defmac
5164
5165@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5166This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5167@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5168is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5169RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5170when it is called.
5171
5172If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5173first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5174from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5175Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5176trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5177to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5178
5179If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5180enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5181initializing the trampoline proper.
5182@end deftypefn
5183
5184@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5185This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5186the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5187memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5188the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5189address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5190be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5191If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5192@end deftypefn
5193
5194Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5195separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5196fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5197jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5198
5199Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5200the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5201make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5202subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5203latter makes initialization faster.
5204
5205To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5206the following macro.
5207
5208@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5209If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5210cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5211typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5212@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5213@end defmac
5214
5215The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5216before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5217the following macro.
5218
5219@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5220Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5221code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5222file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5223named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5224emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5225@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5226@end defmac
5227
5228To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5229you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5230cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5231beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5232its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5233
5234@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5235Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5236work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5237which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5238@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5239
5240If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5241C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5242special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5243statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5244global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5245special assembler code.
5246@end defmac
5247
5248@node Library Calls
5249@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5250@cindex library subroutine names
5251@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5252
5253@c prevent bad page break with this line
5254Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5255
5256@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5257This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5258expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5259provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5260are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5261@end defmac
5262
5263@findex set_optab_libfunc
5264@findex init_one_libfunc
5265@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5266This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5267existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5268@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5269@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5270library routines.
5271
5272The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5273@end deftypefn
5274
5275@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5276This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5277implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5278mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5279return a tristate.
5280
5281GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5282comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5283don't need to define this macro.
5284@end defmac
5285
5286@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5287This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5288functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5289operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5290and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5291If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5292@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5293in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5294@end defmac
5295
5296@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5297@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5298@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5299@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5300@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5301Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5302library to provide floating point emulation.
5303
5304In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5305@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5306else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5307in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5308architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5309an example.
5310
5311If this macro is defined, the
5312@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5313false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5314@end defmac
5315
5316@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5317@findex matherr
5318@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5319The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5320expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5321deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5322@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5323system.
5324
5325If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5326domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5327error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5328there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5329that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5330@end defmac
5331
5332@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5333@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5334Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5335refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5336@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5337macro, a reasonable default is used.
5338@end defmac
5339
5340@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5341@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5342When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5343@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5344default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5345functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5346systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5347@end defmac
5348
5349@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5350@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5351When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5352and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5353default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5354@smallexample
5355void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5356void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5357void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5358@end smallexample
5359@end defmac
5360
5361@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5362Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5363the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5364involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5365at once to the method-lookup library function.
5366
5367The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5368to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5369@end defmac
5370
5371@node Addressing Modes
5372@section Addressing Modes
5373@cindex addressing modes
5374
5375@c prevent bad page break with this line
5376This is about addressing modes.
5377
5378@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5379@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5380@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5381@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5382A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5383pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5384@end defmac
5385
5386@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5387@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5388A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5389post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5390the size of the memory operand.
5391@end defmac
5392
5393@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5394@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5395A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5396post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5397@end defmac
5398
5399@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5400A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5401is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5402@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5403is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5404constant addresses are supported.
5405@end defmac
5406
5407@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5408@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5409accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5410known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5411expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5412@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5413@end defmac
5414
5415@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5416A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5417memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5418the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5419accept.
5420@end defmac
5421
5422@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5423A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5424address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5425
5426Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5427non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5428desired by the caller.
5429
5430The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5431that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5432considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5433kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5434must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5435up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5436register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5437if the array holds @code{-1}.
5438
5439The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5440accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5441register is required.
5442
5443Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5444and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5445constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5446specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5447recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5448
5449Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5450sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5451@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5452naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5453be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5454
5455@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5456On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5457the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5458target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5459into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5460@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5461@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5462Format}.
5463
5464@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5465Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5466this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5467has this syntax:
5468
5469@example
5470#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5471@end example
5472
5473@noindent
5474and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5475address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5476Whether the strict or non-strict variants are desired is defined by
5477the @code{REG_OK_STRICT} macro introduced earlier in this section.
5478Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5479files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5480@end deftypefn
5481
5482@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5483A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5484character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5485letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5486@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5487support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5488semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5489preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5490@code{'m'} constraint.
5491@end defmac
5492
5493@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5494A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5495or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5496can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5497@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5498
5499It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5500that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5501
5502The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5503a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5504@end defmac
5505
5506@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5507This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5508operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5509address.
5510
5511@findex break_out_memory_refs
5512@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5513and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5514@var{x}.
5515
5516The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5517@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5518should return the new @var{x}.
5519
5520It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5521The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5522is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5523a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5524strategy can generate better code.
5525@end deftypefn
5526
5527@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5528A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5529that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5530@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5531It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5532performance reasons.
5533
5534For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5535reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5536registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5537processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5538needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5539@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5540generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5541be shared.
5542
5543@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5544to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5545and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5546of reload internals.
5547
5548@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5549previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5550then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5551
5552@findex push_reload
5553The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5554need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5555suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5556
5557The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5558@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5559should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5560This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5561@code{push_reload}.
5562
5563@findex strict_memory_address_p
5564The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5565the address has become legitimate.
5566
5567@findex copy_rtx
5568If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5569this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5570single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5571top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5572It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5573address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5574@end defmac
5575
5576@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5577This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5578different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5579reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5580but not others.
5581
5582Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5583effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5584of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5585addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5586
5587You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5588
5589The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5590@end deftypefn
5591
5592@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5593A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5594@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5595different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5596reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5597but not others.
5598
5599Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5600effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5601of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5602addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5603
5604You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5605
5606These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5607@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5608@end defmac
5609
5610@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5611A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5612an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5613@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5614@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5615anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5616@end defmac
5617
5618@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5619This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5620@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5621macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5622references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5623addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5624the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5625into their original form.
5626@end deftypefn
5627
5628@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5629This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5630should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5631this hook returns false.
5632
5633The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5634deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5635from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5636holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5637of TLS symbols for various targets.
5638@end deftypefn
5639
5640@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5641This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5642be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5643of @var{x}.
5644
5645The default version returns false for all constants.
5646@end deftypefn
5647
5648@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5649This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5650the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5651@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5652when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5653@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5654of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5655function are valid.
5656@end deftypefn
5657
5658@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5659This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5660address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5661used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5662@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5663
5664The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5665@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5666the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5667@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5668two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5669@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5670the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5671from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5672@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5673@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5674@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5675
5676If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5677to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5678use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5679@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5680should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5681described above.
5682If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5683the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5684log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5685@end deftypefn
5686
5687@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5688This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5689widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5690
5691If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5692@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5693widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5694preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5695@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5696@end deftypefn
5697
5698@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5699This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5700widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5701
5702If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5703@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5704widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5705preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5706@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5707@end deftypefn
5708
5709@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5710Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5711@end deftypefn
5712
5713@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5714Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5715@end deftypefn
5716
5717@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5718Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5719@end deftypefn
5720
5721@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5722Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5723@end deftypefn
5724
5725@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5726This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5727input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5728The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5729specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5730(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5731
5732If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5733@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5734conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5735@end deftypefn
5736
5737@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5738This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5739vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5740@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5741The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5742return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5743@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5744@end deftypefn
5745
5746@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5747This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5748store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5749parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5750the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5751parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5752@end deftypefn
5753
5754@node Anchored Addresses
5755@section Anchored Addresses
5756@cindex anchored addresses
5757@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5758
5759GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5760For example, if we have:
5761
5762@smallexample
5763static int a, b, c;
5764int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5765@end smallexample
5766
5767the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5768addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5769it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5770the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5771be something like:
5772
5773@smallexample
5774int foo (void)
5775@{
5776 register int *xr = &x;
5777 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5778@}
5779@end smallexample
5780
5781(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5782``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5783
5784The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5785in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5786section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5787or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5788
5789@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5790The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5791On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5792applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5793for every mode. The default value is 0.
5794@end deftypevr
5795
5796@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5797Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5798offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5799value is 0.
5800@end deftypevr
5801
5802@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5803Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5804@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5805The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5806of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5807
5808If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5809it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5810If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5811is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5812@end deftypefn
5813
5814@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5815Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5816@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5817@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5818
5819The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5820intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5821or target-specific sections.
5822@end deftypefn
5823
5824@node Condition Code
5825@section Condition Code Status
5826@cindex condition code status
5827
5828The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5829two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5830
5831The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5832(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5833clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5834register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5835architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5836most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5837most RISC machines.
5838
5839The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5840the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5841insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5842optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5843is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5844three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5845scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5846separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5847
5848For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5849represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5850condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5851condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5852or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5853Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5854that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5855
5856Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5857specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5858interested in most macros in this section.
5859
5860@menu
5861* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5862* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5863* Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5864@end menu
5865
5866@node CC0 Condition Codes
5867@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5868@findex cc0
5869
5870@findex cc_status
5871The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5872describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5873the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5874variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5875currently based, and several standard flags.
5876
5877Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5878description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5879information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5880
5881@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5882C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5883component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5884
5885This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5886@end defmac
5887
5888@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5889A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5890The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5891the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5892define this macro to initialize it.
5893
5894This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5895@end defmac
5896
5897@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5898A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5899appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5900this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5901code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5902set @code{(cc0)}.
5903
5904This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5905
5906If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5907other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5908invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5909reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5910registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5911@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5912insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5913based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5914value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5915this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5916@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5917@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5918condition code value.
5919
5920The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5921with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5922@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5923constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5924insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5925@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5926@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5927
5928A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5929that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5930@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5931two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5932@end defmac
5933
5934@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5935@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5936@findex CCmode
5937@findex MODE_CC
5938
5939@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5940On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5941than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5942code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5943when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5944bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5945branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5946this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5947record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5948also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5949unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5950
5951If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5952@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5953a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5954have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5955by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5956be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5957the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5958
5959@smallexample
5960(define_insn ""
5961 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5962 (compare:CC_NOOV
5963 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5964 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5965 (const_int 0)))]
5966 ""
5967 "@dots{}")
5968@end smallexample
5969
5970@noindent
5971together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5972for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5973
5974@smallexample
5975#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5976 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5977 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5978 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5979 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5980 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5981@end smallexample
5982
5983Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5984were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5985this section.
5986
5987You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5988in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5989@end defmac
5990
5991@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5992On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5993convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5994does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5995comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5996
5997On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5998required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5999and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6000comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6001@var{op1} as required.
6002
6003GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6004valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6005@file{md} file.
6006
6007You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6008code or operands.
6009@end defmac
6010
6011@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6012A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6013comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6014can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6015then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6016
6017You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6018floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6019For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6020inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6021
6022@smallexample
6023#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6024@end smallexample
6025@end defmac
6026
6027@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6028A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6029comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6030@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6031machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6032instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6033freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6034like:
6035
6036@smallexample
6037#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6038 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6039 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6040@end smallexample
6041@end defmac
6042
6043@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6044On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6045register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6046regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6047hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6048small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6049to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6050arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6051When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6052integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6053@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6054
6055The default version of this hook returns false.
6056@end deftypefn
6057
6058@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6059On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6060@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6061validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6062target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6063both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6064return @code{VOIDmode}.
6065
6066The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6067same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6068returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6069@end deftypefn
6070
6071@node Cond. Exec. Macros
6072@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6073@findex conditional execution
6074@findex predication
6075
6076There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6077supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6078represent conditional branches.
6079
6080@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6081A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6082@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6083versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6084predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6085that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6086If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6087
6088@smallexample
6089#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6090 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6091@end smallexample
6092@end defmac
6093
6094@node Costs
6095@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6096@cindex costs of instructions
6097@cindex relative costs
6098@cindex speed of instructions
6099
6100These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6101on the target machine.
6102
6103@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6104A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6105register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6106expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6107value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6108that.
6109
6110It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6111same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6112registers if they are not general registers.
6113
6114If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6115hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6116classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6117constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6118allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6119if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6120
6121These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6122@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6123@end defmac
6124
6125@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6126This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6127from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6128are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6129A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6130that.
6131
6132It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6133same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6134registers if they are not general registers.
6135
6136If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6137hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6138classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6139constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6140allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6141if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6142
6143The default version of this function returns 2.
6144@end deftypefn
6145
6146@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6147A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6148register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6149is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6150is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6151registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6152should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6153
6154If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6155the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6156needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6157between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6158more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6159reflect the actual cost of the move.
6160
6161GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6162secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6163a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6164secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61654 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6166value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6167are the same as to this macro.
6168
6169These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6170@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6171@end defmac
6172
6173@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, enum reg_class @var{regclass}, bool @var{in})
6174This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6175between a register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6176if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6177This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6178If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6179registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6180
6181If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6182the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6183needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6184between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6185more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6186reflect the actual cost of the move.
6187
6188GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6189secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6190a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6191secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61924 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6193value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6194are the same as to this target hook.
6195@end deftypefn
6196
6197@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6198A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6199default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6200is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6201it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6202rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6203predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6204reduced then.
6205@end defmac
6206
6207Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6208but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6209ordinarily expect.
6210
6211@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6212Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6213than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6214faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6215require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6216between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6217
6218When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6219finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6220load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6221faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6222may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6223other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6224@end defmac
6225
6226@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6227Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6228@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6229than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6230handler.
6231
6232When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6233@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6234moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6235Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6236cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6237
6238If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6239this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6240@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6241@end defmac
6242
6243@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6244The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6245which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6246string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6247make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6248
6249Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6250@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6251the number of such sequences.
6252
6253The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6254optimized for speed rather than size.
6255
6256If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6257@end defmac
6258
6259@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6260A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6261copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6262will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6263than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6264@end defmac
6265
6266@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6267A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6268a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6269@end defmac
6270
6271@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6272The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6273of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6274or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6275eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6276
6277The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6278optimized for speed rather than size.
6279
6280If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6281@end defmac
6282
6283@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6284A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6285to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6286will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6287than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6288@end defmac
6289
6290@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6291The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6292of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6293a block set insn or a library call.
6294Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6295eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6296
6297The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6298optimized for speed rather than size.
6299
6300If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6301@end defmac
6302
6303@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6304A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6305used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6306other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6307storing values other than constant zero.
6308Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6309than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6310@end defmac
6311
6312@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6313A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6314used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6315other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6316called with a constant source string.
6317Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6318than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6319@end defmac
6320
6321@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6322A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6323thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6324@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6325@end defmac
6326
6327@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6328A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6329thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6330@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6331@end defmac
6332
6333@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6334A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6335thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6336@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6337@end defmac
6338
6339@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6340A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6341thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6342@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6343@end defmac
6344
6345@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6346A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6347thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6348@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6349@end defmac
6350
6351@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6352A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6353thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6354@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6355@end defmac
6356
6357@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6358This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6359thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6360@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6361@end defmac
6362
6363@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6364This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6365thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6366@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6367@end defmac
6368
6369@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6370Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6371function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6372@end defmac
6373
6374@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6375Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6376@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6377@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6378@end defmac
6379
6380@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6381This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6382
6383The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6384available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6385in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6386expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6387@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6388
6389In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6390@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6391instructions.
6392
6393On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6394for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6395necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6396for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6397operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6398
6399When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6400false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6401size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6402
6403The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6404processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6405@end deftypefn
6406
6407@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6408This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6409@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6410the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6411
6412For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6413true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6414instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6415all addresses will have equal costs.
6416
6417In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6418the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6419cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6420
6421For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6422and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6423is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6424references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6425the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6426that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6427instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6428specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6429
6430This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6431
6432On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6433cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6434@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6435be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6436@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6437should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6438should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6439registers on machines with lots of registers.
6440@end deftypefn
6441
6442@node Scheduling
6443@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6444
6445The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6446adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6447hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6448them: try the first ones in this list first.
6449
6450@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6451This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6452issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6453Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6454an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6455constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6456hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6457This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6458it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6459@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6460@end deftypefn
6461
6462@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6463This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6464from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6465still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6466@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6467@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6468You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6469than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6470@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6471debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6472@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6473was scheduled.
6474@end deftypefn
6475
6476@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6477This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6478relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6479dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6480is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6481to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6482that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6483data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6484description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6485output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6486times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6487acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6488@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6489@end deftypefn
6490
6491@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6492This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6493@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6494execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6495later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6496scheduling priorities of insns.
6497@end deftypefn
6498
6499@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6500This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6501list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6502combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6503@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6504debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6505@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6506list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6507a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6508reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6509@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6510is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6511the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6512can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6513@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6514@end deftypefn
6515
6516@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6517Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6518function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6519is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6520@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6521return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6522this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6523scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6524cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6525@end deftypefn
6526
6527@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6528This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6529chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6530correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6531example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6532analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6533dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6534calculated.
6535@end deftypefn
6536
6537@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6538This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6539instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6540pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6541is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6542@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6543region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6544scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6545@end deftypefn
6546
6547@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6548This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6549instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6550cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6551is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6552to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6553@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6557This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6558@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6559@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6560@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6561@end deftypefn
6562
6563@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6564This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6565@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6566@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6567@end deftypefn
6568
6569@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6570The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6571pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6572when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6573simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6574processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6575based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6576when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6577@end deftypefn
6578
6579@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6580The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6581@end deftypefn
6582
6583@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6584The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6585to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6586simulated processor cycle finishes.
6587@end deftypefn
6588
6589@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6590The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6591used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6592@end deftypefn
6593
6594@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6595The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6596The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6597to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6598state on a single insn is not enough.
6599@end deftypefn
6600
6601@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6602The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6603The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6604to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6605state on a single insn is not enough.
6606@end deftypefn
6607
6608@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6609This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6610for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6611chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6612value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6613@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6614subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6615maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6616@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6617packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6618rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6619
6620This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6621processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6622with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6623@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6624@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6625processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6626@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6627until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6628the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6629
6630Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6631pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6632schedules to choose the best one.
6633
6634The default is no multipass scheduling.
6635@end deftypefn
6636
6637@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6638
6639This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6640considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6641zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6642be issued.
6643
6644The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6645@end deftypefn
6646
6647@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6648
6649This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6650on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6651@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6652the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6653is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6654start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6655verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6656@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6657processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6658and the current processor cycle.
6659@end deftypefn
6660
6661@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6662This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6663the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6664are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6665to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6666being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6667dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6668parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6669The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6670insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6671and @code{false} otherwise.
6672
6673Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6674where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6675delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6676that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6677important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6678closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6679not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6680@end deftypefn
6681
6682@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6683This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6684the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6685per instruction data structures.
6686@end deftypefn
6687
6688@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6689Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6690@end deftypefn
6691
6692@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6693Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6694It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6695beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6696@end deftypefn
6697
6698@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6699Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6700@end deftypefn
6701
6702@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6703Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6704@end deftypefn
6705
6706@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6707Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6708@end deftypefn
6709
6710@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6711This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6712speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6713The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6714version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6715pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6716or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6717speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6718the generated speculative pattern.
6719@end deftypefn
6720
6721@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6722This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6723for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6724instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6725@end deftypefn
6726
6727@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6728This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6729check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6730speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6731@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6732be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6733recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6734a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6735@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6736@end deftypefn
6737
6738@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6739This hook is used as a workaround for
6740@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6741called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6742discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6743being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6744@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6745For non-speculative instructions,
6746the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6747the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6748is nearly full.
6749@end deftypefn
6750
6751@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6752This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6753enabled/used.
6754The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6755The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6756@end deftypefn
6757
6758@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6759This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6760resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6761the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6762backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6763bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6764of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6765@end deftypefn
6766
6767@node Sections
6768@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6769@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6770@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6771
6772An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6773data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6774section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6775section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6776section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6777of sections.
6778
6779@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6780@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6781The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6782is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6783as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6784initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6785They may however depend on command-line flags.
6786
6787@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6788use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6789to be string literals.
6790
6791Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6792section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6793should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6794@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6795
6796You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6797@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6798in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6799@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6800create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6801reuse @code{text_section}.
6802
6803All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6804if the target does not provide them.
6805
6806@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6807A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6808assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6809Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6810@end defmac
6811
6812@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6813If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6814frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6815a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6816@end defmac
6817
6818@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6819If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6820executed functions in the program.
6821@end defmac
6822
6823@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6824A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6825assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6826data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6827@end defmac
6828
6829@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6830If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6831containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6832initialized, writable small data.
6833@end defmac
6834
6835@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6836A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6837assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6838data.
6839@end defmac
6840
6841@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6842If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6843containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6844uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6845@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6846uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6847@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6848used.
6849@end defmac
6850
6851@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6852If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6853containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6854uninitialized, writable small data.
6855@end defmac
6856
6857@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6858If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6859assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6860common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6861@end defmac
6862
6863@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6864If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6865containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6866default is @code{'T'}.
6867@end defmac
6868
6869@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6870If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6871containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6872initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6873not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6874variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6875@end defmac
6876
6877@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6878If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6879containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6880finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6881not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6882variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6883@end defmac
6884
6885@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6886If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6887containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6888part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6889defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6890both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6891@end defmac
6892
6893@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6894If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6895containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6896part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6897defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6898both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6899@end defmac
6900
6901@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6902If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6903via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6904the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6905@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6906to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6907sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6908ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6909registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6910constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6911@end defmac
6912
6913@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6914If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6915variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6916when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6917you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6918they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6919expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6920MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6921require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6922to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6923access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6924@end defmac
6925
6926@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6927If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6928arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6929@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6930and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6931@end defmac
6932
6933@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6934Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6935tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6936section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6937readonly data section is used.
6938
6939This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6940@end defmac
6941
6942@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6943Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6944@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6945of its own that you need to create.
6946
6947GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6948any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6949described below.
6950@end deftypefn
6951
6952@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6953Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6954selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6955should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6956local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6957
6958The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6959is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6960when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6961in read-only sections even in executables.
6962@end deftypefn
6963
6964@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6965Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6966assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6967some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6968requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6969local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6970@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6971
6972The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6973variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6974
6975See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6976@end deftypefn
6977
6978@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6979Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6980for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6981
6982In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6983function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6984it is unlikely to be called.
6985@end defmac
6986
6987@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6988Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6989and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6990As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6991the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6992
6993The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6994ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6995example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6996Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6997@end deftypefn
6998
6999@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7000Return the readonly data section associated with
7001@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7002The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7003the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7004if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7005otherwise.
7006@end deftypefn
7007
7008@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7009Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7010should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7011constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7012case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7013in bits.
7014
7015The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7016constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7017else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7018@end deftypefn
7019
7020@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7021Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7022by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7023the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7024or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7025hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7026your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7027returns the @var{id} provided.
7028@end deftypefn
7029
7030@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7031Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7032treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7033function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7034
7035The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7036@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7037an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7038rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7039in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7040
7041In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7042a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7043will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7044register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7045rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7046leave it alone.)
7047
7048The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7049that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7050be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7051declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7052declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7053@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7054
7055@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7056The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7057@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7058Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7059encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7060discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7061
7062The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7063in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7064@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7065before overriding it.
7066@end deftypefn
7067
7068@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7069Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7070the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7071may have added.
7072@end deftypefn
7073
7074@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7075Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7076The default version of this hook always returns false.
7077@end deftypefn
7078
7079@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7080Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7081``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7082@end deftypevr
7083
7084@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7085Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7086rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7087or executable image).
7088
7089The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7090for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7091currently supported object file formats.
7092@end deftypefn
7093
7094@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7095Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7096The default value is false.
7097@end deftypevr
7098
7099
7100@node PIC
7101@section Position Independent Code
7102@cindex position independent code
7103@cindex PIC
7104
7105This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7106independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7107generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7108@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7109@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7110must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7111when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7112need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7113relative addresses.
7114@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7115@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7116
7117@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7118The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7119data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7120processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7121is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7122pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7123is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7124necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7125when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7126@end defmac
7127
7128@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7129Define this macro if the register defined by
7130@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. Do not define
7131this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7132@end defmac
7133
7134@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7135A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7136operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7137You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7138check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7139check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7140(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7141position independent code.
7142@end defmac
7143
7144@node Assembler Format
7145@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7146
7147This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7148to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7149instructions do.
7150
7151@menu
7152* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7153* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7154* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7155* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7156* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7157 and termination routines.
7158* Macros for Initialization::
7159 Specific macros that control the handling of
7160 initialization and termination routines.
7161* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7162* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7163* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7164* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7165@end menu
7166
7167@node File Framework
7168@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7169@cindex assembler format
7170@cindex output of assembler code
7171
7172@c prevent bad page break with this line
7173This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7174
7175@findex default_file_start
7176@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7177Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7178find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7179by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7180quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7181@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7182lets other target files rely on these variables.
7183@end deftypefn
7184
7185@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7186If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7187printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7188@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7189to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7190definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7191assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7192whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7193
7194The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7195verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7196comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7197@end deftypevr
7198
7199@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7200If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7201for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7202@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7203this to be done. The default is false.
7204@end deftypevr
7205
7206@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7207Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7208to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7209@end deftypefn
7210
7211@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7212Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7213special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7214the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7215should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7216need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7217this function.
7218@end deftypefun
7219
7220@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7221Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7222to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7223nothing.
7224@end deftypefn
7225
7226@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7227Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7228to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7229nothing.
7230@end deftypefn
7231
7232@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7233Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7234unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7235here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7236because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7237nothing.
7238@end deftypefn
7239
7240@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7241A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7242assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7243the end of the line.
7244@end defmac
7245
7246@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7247A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7248statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7249@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7250assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7251that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7252@end defmac
7253
7254@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7255A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7256statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7257@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7258time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7259@end defmac
7260
7261@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7262A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7263which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7264the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7265
7266This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7267for the file format in use is appropriate.
7268@end defmac
7269
7270@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7271A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7272@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7273in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7274the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7275of the filename using this macro.
7276@end defmac
7277
7278@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7279A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7280@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7281macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7282@end defmac
7283
7284@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7285Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7286should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7287of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7288is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7289this section is associated.
7290@end deftypefn
7291
7292@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7293This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7294@end deftypevr
7295
7296@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7297@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7298This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7299section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7300This is true on most ELF targets.
7301@end deftypevr
7302
7303@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7304Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7305based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7306declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7307null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7308
7309The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7310read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7311need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7312set via @code{__attribute__}.
7313@end deftypefn
7314
7315@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7316Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7317switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7318enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7319It can take the following values:
7320
7321@table @gcctabopt
7322@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7323@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7324
7325@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7326@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7327direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7328default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7329command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7330various different individual optimization passes.
7331
7332@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7333@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7334ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7335target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7336time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7337warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7338wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7339necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7340perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7341switches.
7342
7343@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7344This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7345
7346@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7347This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7348@end table
7349
7350The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7351supported in the future.
7352
7353By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7354provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7355it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7356section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7357provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7358hook.
7359@end deftypefn
7360
7361@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7362This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7363ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7364hook.
7365@end deftypevr
7366
7367@need 2000
7368@node Data Output
7369@subsection Output of Data
7370
7371
7372@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7373@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7374@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7375@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7376@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7377@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7378@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7379@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7380@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7381These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7382of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7383byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7384aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7385@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7386
7387The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7388followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7389the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7390@end deftypevr
7391
7392@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7393The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7394integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7395in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7396function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7397object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7398split the object into smaller parts.
7399
7400The default implementation of this hook will use the
7401@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7402when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7403@end deftypefn
7404
7405@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7406A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7407@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7408@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7409allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7410
7411If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7412@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7413prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7414@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7415@end defmac
7416
7417@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7418A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7419instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7420bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7421@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7422
7423If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7424Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7425@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7426@end defmac
7427
7428@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7429A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7430@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7431is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7432@end defmac
7433
7434@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7435You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7436expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7437pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7438GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7439not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7440pool before the function.
7441@end defmac
7442
7443@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7444A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7445constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7446the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7447be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7448is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7449immediately after this call.
7450
7451If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7452not be defined.
7453@end defmac
7454
7455@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7456A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7457constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7458anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7459
7460The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7461assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7462output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7463@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7464@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7465alignment.
7466
7467The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7468the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7469responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7470Here is how to do this:
7471
7472@smallexample
7473@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7474@end smallexample
7475
7476When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7477@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7478entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7479
7480You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7481@end defmac
7482
7483@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7484A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7485pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7486function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7487obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7488constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7489
7490If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7491define this macro.
7492@end defmac
7493
7494@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7495Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7496used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7497to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7498a line separator uses multiple characters.
7499
7500If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7501the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7502@end defmac
7503
7504@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7505These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7506assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7507default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7508@end deftypevr
7509
7510These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7511of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7512
7513@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7514@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7515@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7516@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7517@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7518@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7519These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7520target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7521the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7522@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7523simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7524@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7525by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7526it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
752732 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7528on the host machine.
7529
7530The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7531using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7532machine's memory.
7533@end defmac
7534
7535@node Uninitialized Data
7536@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7537
7538Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7539outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7540
7541@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7542A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7543@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7544@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7545is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7546possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7547other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7548backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7549byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7550equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7551the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7552an ordinary undefined external.
7553
7554Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7555output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7556assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7557
7558This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7559common global variables are output.
7560@end defmac
7561
7562@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7563Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7564separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7565place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7566handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7567as the number of bits.
7568@end defmac
7569
7570@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7571Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7572variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7573is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7574in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7575@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7576the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7577@end defmac
7578
7579@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7580A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7581@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7582@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7583is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7584
7585Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7586defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7587@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7588before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7589the name, and a newline.
7590
7591There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7592this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7593The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7594switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7595You do not need to do both.
7596
7597Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7598non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7599efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7600not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7601common in order to save space in the object file.
7602@end defmac
7603
7604@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7605Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7606separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7607place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7608handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7609as the number of bits.
7610
7611Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7612@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7613@end defmac
7614
7615@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7616A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7617@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7618@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7619is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7620
7621Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7622output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7623assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7624
7625This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7626static variables are output.
7627@end defmac
7628
7629@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7630Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7631separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7632place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7633handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7634as the number of bits.
7635@end defmac
7636
7637@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7638Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7639variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7640is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7641in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7642@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7643the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7644@end defmac
7645
7646@node Label Output
7647@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7648
7649@c prevent bad page break with this line
7650This is about outputting labels.
7651
7652@findex assemble_name
7653@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7654A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7655@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7656Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7657output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7658assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7659definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7660@end defmac
7661
7662@findex assemble_name_raw
7663@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7664Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7665to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7666@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7667that it is more efficient.
7668@end defmac
7669
7670@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7671A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7672size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7673default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7674systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7675
7676Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7677of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7678for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7679macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7680define this macro.
7681@end defmac
7682
7683@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7684A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7685@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7686symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7687If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7688provided.
7689@end defmac
7690
7691@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7692A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7693@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7694the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7695address.
7696
7697If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7698provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7699@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7700the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7701not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7702to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7703@end defmac
7704
7705@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7706A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7707type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7708default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7709systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7710
7711Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7712@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7713custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7714types at all, do not define this macro.
7715@end defmac
7716
7717@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7718A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7719the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7720default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7721the default is not to define this macro.
7722
7723Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7724@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7725custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7726types at all, do not define this macro.
7727@end defmac
7728
7729@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7730A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7731@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7732symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7733that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7734you should not count on this.
7735
7736If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7737definition of this macro is provided.
7738@end defmac
7739
7740@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7741A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7742@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7743function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7744outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7745@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7746@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7747
7748If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7749usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7750
7751You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7752of this macro.
7753@end defmac
7754
7755@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7756A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7757@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7758which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7759function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7760representing the function.
7761
7762If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7763
7764You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7765of this macro.
7766@end defmac
7767
7768@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7769A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7770@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7771initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7772label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7773@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7774
7775If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7776usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7777
7778You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7779@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7780@end defmac
7781
7782@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE * @var{file}, const char * @var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7783A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7784for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7785target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7786@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7787and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7788will be an internal label.
7789
7790The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7791usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7792
7793You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7794@end deftypefn
7795
7796@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7797A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7798@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7799for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7800
7801If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7802nothing.
7803@end defmac
7804
7805@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7806A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7807once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7808chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7809initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7810something about the size of the object.
7811
7812If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7813nothing.
7814
7815You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7816@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7817@end defmac
7818
7819@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7820This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7821@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7822that is, available for reference from other files.
7823
7824The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7825@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7826@end deftypefn
7827
7828@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7829This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7830@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7831global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7832
7833The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7834@end deftypefn
7835
7836@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7837A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7838@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7839that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7840no other definition is available. Use the expression
7841@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7842itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7843for making that name weak, and a newline.
7844
7845If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7846support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7847macro.
7848@end defmac
7849
7850@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7851Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7852@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7853or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7854should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7855defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7856@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7857to make @var{name} weak.
7858@end defmac
7859
7860@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7861Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7862symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7863declaration of @code{name}.
7864@end defmac
7865
7866@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
7867A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7868
7869If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7870definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
7871is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
7872@samp{0}. Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
7873with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
7874@end defmac
7875
7876@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7877A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7878public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7879be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7880format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7881section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7882requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7883@end defmac
7884
7885@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7886A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7887semantics.
7888
7889If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7890definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7891definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7892you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7893setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7894be emitted as one-only.
7895@end defmac
7896
7897@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7898This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7899commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7900hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7901@end deftypefn
7902
7903@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7904A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7905that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7906The default is @code{0}.
7907
7908Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7909if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7910will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7911symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7912thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7913(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7914with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7915
7916The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7917targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7918restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7919table of contents.
7920@end defmac
7921
7922@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7923A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7924@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7925symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7926not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7927declaration.
7928
7929This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7930The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7931@end defmac
7932
7933@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7934This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7935pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7936library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7937@end deftypefn
7938
7939@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7940This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7941directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7942.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7943@end deftypefn
7944
7945@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7946A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7947@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7948@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7949is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7950systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7951@end defmac
7952
7953@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7954A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7955@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7956will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7957to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7958encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7959@end defmac
7960
7961@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7962A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7963result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7964@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7965This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7966specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7967when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7968being taken.
7969@end defmac
7970
7971@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
7972A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7973name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
7974
7975It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
7976used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
7977will have name conflicts with internal labels.
7978
7979It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
7980object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
7981should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
7982beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
7983convention your system uses, and follow it.
7984
7985The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
7986@end deftypefn
7987
7988@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
7989A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
7990label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
7991@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
7992may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
7993systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
7994bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
7995bundles.
7996
7997If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
7998used.
7999@end defmac
8000
8001@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8002A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8003is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8004
8005This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8006produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8007with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8008
8009If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8010output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8011@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8012string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8013to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8014@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8015you should know what it does on your machine.)
8016@end defmac
8017
8018@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8019A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8020@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8021@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8022added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8023
8024The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8025produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8026@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8027assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8028macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8029internal static variables in different scopes.
8030
8031Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8032conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8033or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8034between the name and the number will suffice.
8035
8036If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8037which is correct for most systems.
8038@end defmac
8039
8040@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8041A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8042which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8043
8044@findex SET_ASM_OP
8045If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8046correct for most systems.
8047@end defmac
8048
8049@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8050A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8051which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8052to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8053be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8054the tree nodes are available.
8055
8056@findex SET_ASM_OP
8057If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8058correct for most systems.
8059@end defmac
8060
8061@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8062A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8063(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8064of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8065current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8066This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8067@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8068@end defmac
8069
8070@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8071A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8072which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8073@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8074an undefined weak symbol.
8075
8076Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8077@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8078@end defmac
8079
8080@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8081Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8082Objective-C methods.
8083
8084The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8085class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8086the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8087@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8088
8089These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8090the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8091systems define other ways of computing names.
8092
8093@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8094buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8095@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
809650 characters extra.
8097
8098The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8099method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8100@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8101in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8102
8103On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8104macro to provide more human-readable names.
8105@end defmac
8106
8107@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8108A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8109@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8110Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8111linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8112@end defmac
8113
8114@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8115A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8116@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8117unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8118whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8119@end defmac
8120
8121@node Initialization
8122@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8123@cindex initialization routines
8124@cindex termination routines
8125@cindex constructors, output of
8126@cindex destructors, output of
8127
8128The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8129(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8130data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8131to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8132@code{main} is called.
8133
8134Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8135@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8136terminates.
8137
8138To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8139must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8140be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8141system, you need to specify how to do this.
8142
8143There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8144initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8145Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8146
8147@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8148@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8149The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8150initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8151termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8152
8153Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81540, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8155the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8156pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8157pointer containing zero.
8158
8159Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8160@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8161time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8162list; destructors in forward order.
8163
8164The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8165formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8166aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8167Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8168object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8169the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8170accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8171Termination functions are handled similarly.
8172
8173This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8174@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8175support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8176constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8177and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8178
8179When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8180upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8181support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8182parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8183program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8184
8185@smallexample
8186ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8187@end smallexample
8188
8189The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8190section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8191for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8192files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8193are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8194
8195The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8196compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8197fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8198to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8199of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8200that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8201
8202To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8203macro properly.
8204
8205If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8206@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8207entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8208it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8209after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8210in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8211
8212In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8213two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8214and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8215@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8216entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8217and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8218code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8219the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8220placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8221a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8222@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8223section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8224the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8225the initialization process.
8226
8227The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8228This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8229file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8230this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8231termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8232an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8233pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8234the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8235initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8236via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8237@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8238
8239@ifinfo
8240The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8241customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8242@end ifinfo
8243
8244@node Macros for Initialization
8245@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8246
8247Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8248and termination functions:
8249
8250@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8251If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8252operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8253defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8254using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8255macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8256run the initialization functions.
8257@end defmac
8258
8259@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8260If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8261This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8262on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8263be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8264@end defmac
8265
8266@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8267If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8268the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8269@end defmac
8270
8271@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8272If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8273the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8274@end defmac
8275
8276@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8277If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8278automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8279should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8280the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8281function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8282
8283This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8284shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8285exception tables embedded in the code.
8286@end defmac
8287
8288@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8289If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8290automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8291should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8292the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8293function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8294@end defmac
8295
8296@defmac INVOKE__main
8297If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8298@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8299where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8300useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8301@end defmac
8302
8303@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8304If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8305compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8306of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8307encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8308@end defmac
8309
8310@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8311This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8312collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8313It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8314@end deftypevr
8315
8316@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8317If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8318the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8319
8320Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8321no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8322priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8323otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8324
8325If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8326be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8327target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8328is not defined.
8329@end deftypefn
8330
8331@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8332This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8333functions rather than initialization functions.
8334@end deftypefn
8335
8336If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8337generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8338
8339If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8340constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8341an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8342
8343On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8344@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8345
8346@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8347Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8348object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8349object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8350
8351This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8352part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8353@end defmac
8354
8355@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8356Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8357to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8358@command{nm}.
8359
8360If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8361dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8362these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8363termination functions in shared libraries:
8364@end defmac
8365
8366@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8367Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8368which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
8369@end defmac
8370
8371@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8372Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8373of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8374of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8375from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8376code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8377line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8378@end defmac
8379
8380@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8381Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8382library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8383strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8384constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8385that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8386@end defmac
8387
8388@node Instruction Output
8389@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8390
8391@c prevent bad page break with this line
8392This describes assembler instruction output.
8393
8394@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8395A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8396registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8397register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8398@end defmac
8399
8400@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8401If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8402and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8403registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8404to registers using alternate names.
8405@end defmac
8406
8407@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8408Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8409requires different names for the machine instructions.
8410
8411The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8412assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8413macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8414points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8415written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8416opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8417increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8418so that it will not be output twice.
8419
8420In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8421name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8422that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8423care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8424@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8425
8426@findex recog_data.operand
8427If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8428elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8429
8430If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8431in the usual way.
8432@end defmac
8433
8434@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8435If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8436assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8437they will be output differently.
8438
8439Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8440extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8441elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8442The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8443template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8444by changing the contents of the vector.
8445
8446This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8447file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8448can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8449as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8450syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8451writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8452
8453If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8454@end defmac
8455
8456@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8457If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8458output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8459if necessary.
8460
8461Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8462extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8463elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8464The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8465template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8466by checking the contents of the vector.
8467@end deftypefn
8468
8469@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8470A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8471assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8472RTL expression.
8473
8474@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8475of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8476printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8477the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8478operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8479@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8480@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8481
8482@findex reg_names
8483If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8484The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8485@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8486@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8487
8488When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8489(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8490with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8491@var{code}.
8492@end defmac
8493
8494@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8495A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8496punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8497@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8498punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8499in this way.
8500@end defmac
8501
8502@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8503A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8504assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8505whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8506
8507@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8508On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8509section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8510@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8511@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8512Format}.
8513@end defmac
8514
8515@findex dbr_sequence_length
8516@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8517A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8518been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8519determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8520currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8521or whatever.
8522
8523Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8524reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8525explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8526@end defmac
8527
8528@findex final_sequence
8529Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8530prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8531(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8532found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8533processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8534being output.
8535
8536@findex asm_fprintf
8537@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8538@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8539@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8540@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8541If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8542@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8543@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8544support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8545files can define these macros differently.
8546@end defmac
8547
8548@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8549If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8550statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8551the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8552printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8553statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8554generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8555specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8556The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8557string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8558upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8559@end defmac
8560
8561@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8562If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8563different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8564numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8565first variant.
8566
8567If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8568@smallexample
8569@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8570@end smallexample
8571@noindent
8572in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8573first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8574@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8575@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8576within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8577alternatives within the braces than the value of
8578@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8579
8580If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8581@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8582operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8583
8584Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8585@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8586the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8587@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8588if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8589opcodes or operand order.
8590@end defmac
8591
8592@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8593A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8594which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8595The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8596profiling.
8597@end defmac
8598
8599@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8600A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8601which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8602The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8603profiling.
8604@end defmac
8605
8606@node Dispatch Tables
8607@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8608
8609@c prevent bad page break with this line
8610This concerns dispatch tables.
8611
8612@cindex dispatch table
8613@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8614A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8615pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8616@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8617definitions of these labels are output using
8618@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8619way here. For example,
8620
8621@smallexample
8622fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8623 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8624@end smallexample
8625
8626You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8627dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8628will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8629@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8630mode and flags can be read.
8631@end defmac
8632
8633@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8634This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8635in a dispatch table are absolute.
8636
8637The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8638@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8639a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8640definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8641For example,
8642
8643@smallexample
8644fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8645@end smallexample
8646@end defmac
8647
8648@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8649Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8650specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8651@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8652jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8653@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8654
8655This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8656for the table.
8657
8658If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8659@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8660@end defmac
8661
8662@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8663Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8664jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8665after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8666the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8667@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8668of the preceding label.
8669
8670If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8671the jump-table.
8672@end defmac
8673
8674@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8675This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8676should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8677should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8678function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8679The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8680exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8681true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8682
8683The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8684@end deftypefn
8685
8686@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8687This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8688It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8689to be broken up according to function.
8690
8691The default is that no label is emitted.
8692@end deftypefn
8693
8694@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8695This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8696given instruction. This is only used when TARGET_UNWIND_INFO is set.
8697@end deftypefn
8698
8699@node Exception Region Output
8700@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8701
8702@c prevent bad page break with this line
8703
8704This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8705region.
8706
8707@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8708If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8709exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8710provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8711@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8712
8713You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8714unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8715@end defmac
8716
8717@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8718If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8719data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8720might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8721collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8722
8723Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8724also defined.
8725@end defmac
8726
8727@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8728Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8729information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8730runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8731and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8732@end defmac
8733
8734@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8735An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8736that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8737@end defmac
8738
8739@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8740Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8741information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8742Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8743@samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8744or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8745
8746If @code{TARGET_UNWIND_INFO} is defined, the target specific unwinder
8747will be used in all cases. Defining this macro will enable the generation
8748of DWARF 2 frame debugging information.
8749
8750If @code{TARGET_UNWIND_INFO} is not defined, and this macro is defined to 1,
8751the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default exception handling mechanism;
8752otherwise, the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme will be used by
8753default.
8754@end defmac
8755
8756@defmac TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
8757Define this macro if your target has ABI specified unwind tables. Usually
8758these will be output by @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}.
8759@end defmac
8760
8761@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8762This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8763tables even when exceptions are not used.
8764@end deftypevr
8765
8766@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8767This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8768runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8769determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8770so the target must provide it directly.
8771@end defmac
8772
8773@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8774Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8775should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8776instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8777@end defmac
8778
8779@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8780This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8781function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8782@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8783alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8784minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8785the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8786@end defmac
8787
8788@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8789Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8790end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8791Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8792true otherwise.
8793@end deftypevr
8794
8795@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8796Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8797represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8798register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8799locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8800register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8801If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8802@end deftypefn
8803
8804@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8805If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8806multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8807sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8808It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8809filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8810@var{address} is the address of the table.
8811@end deftypefn
8812
8813@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8814This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8815the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8816if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8817reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8818@end deftypefn
8819
8820@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8821This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8822based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8823the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8824running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8825@end deftypevr
8826
8827@node Alignment Output
8828@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8829
8830@c prevent bad page break with this line
8831This describes commands for alignment.
8832
8833@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8834The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8835a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8836
8837This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8838to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8839define the macro.
8840
8841Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8842to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8843@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8844selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8845@end defmac
8846
8847@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8848The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8849a @code{BARRIER}.
8850
8851This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8852to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8853define the macro.
8854@end defmac
8855
8856@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8857The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
8858@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8859@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8860@end defmac
8861
8862@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8863The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8864a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8865
8866This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8867to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8868define the macro.
8869
8870Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8871to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8872@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8873selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8874@end defmac
8875
8876@defmac LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8877The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
8878This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8879@end defmac
8880
8881@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8882The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8883If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8884the maximum of the specified values is used.
8885
8886Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8887to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8888@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8889selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8890@end defmac
8891
8892@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8893The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
8894This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8895@end defmac
8896
8897@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8898A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8899instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8900Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8901expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8902@end defmac
8903
8904@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8905Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8906text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8907This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8908produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8909section.
8910@end defmac
8911
8912@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8913A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8914command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8915@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8916@end defmac
8917
8918@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8919Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8920for padding, if necessary.
8921@end defmac
8922
8923@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8924A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8925command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8926@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8927satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8928a C expression of type @code{int}.
8929@end defmac
8930
8931@need 3000
8932@node Debugging Info
8933@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8934
8935@c prevent bad page break with this line
8936This describes how to specify debugging information.
8937
8938@menu
8939* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
8940* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
8941* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
8942* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
8943* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
8944* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
8945@end menu
8946
8947@node All Debuggers
8948@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
8949
8950@c prevent bad page break with this line
8951These macros affect all debugging formats.
8952
8953@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
8954A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
8955register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
8956of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
8957some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
8958versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
8959compiler and another for DBX@.
8960
8961If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
8962used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
8963consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
8964Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
8965expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
8966
8967If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
8968does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
8969redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
8970@end defmac
8971
8972@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
8973A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
8974variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
8975computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
8976gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
8977that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
8978for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
8979@option{-g} options is used.
8980@end defmac
8981
8982@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
8983A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
8984having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
8985@var{offset}.
8986@end defmac
8987
8988@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
8989A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
8990produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
8991this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
8992debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
8993@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
8994@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
8995
8996When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
8997value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
8998exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
8999value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9000defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9001
9002The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9003user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9004@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9005@end defmac
9006
9007@node DBX Options
9008@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9009
9010@c prevent bad page break with this line
9011These are specific options for DBX output.
9012
9013@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9014Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9015in response to the @option{-g} option.
9016@end defmac
9017
9018@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9019Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9020in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9021@end defmac
9022
9023@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9024Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9025GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9026debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9027macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9028if there is any occasion to.
9029@end defmac
9030
9031@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9032Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9033in the text section.
9034@end defmac
9035
9036@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9037A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9038use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9039If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9040applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9041@end defmac
9042
9043@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9044A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9045use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9046value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9047@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9048information format.
9049@end defmac
9050
9051@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9052A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9053use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9054name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9055macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9056@end defmac
9057
9058@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9059Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9060@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9061describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9062On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9063@end defmac
9064
9065@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9066A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9067continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9068exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9069operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9070must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9071with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9072defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9073@end defmac
9074
9075@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9076Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9077the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9078a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9079constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9080if backslash is correct for your system.
9081@end defmac
9082
9083@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9084Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9085outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9086variable.
9087@end defmac
9088
9089@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9090The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9091for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9092@end defmac
9093
9094@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9095The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9096for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9097provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9098@end defmac
9099
9100@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9101The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9102for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9103``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9104@end defmac
9105
9106@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9107The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9108passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9109do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9110@end defmac
9111
9112@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9113Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9114arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9115in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9116code.
9117@end defmac
9118
9119@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9120Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9121the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9122relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9123an absolute address.
9124@end defmac
9125
9126@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9127Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9128the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9129start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9130@end defmac
9131
9132@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9133Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9134@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9135macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9136number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9137generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9138number for a type number.
9139@end defmac
9140
9141@node DBX Hooks
9142@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9143
9144@c prevent bad page break with this line
9145These are hooks for DBX format.
9146
9147@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9148Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9149information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9150argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9151@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9152@end defmac
9153
9154@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9155Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9156@end defmac
9157
9158@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9159Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9160output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9161@end defmac
9162
9163@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9164A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9165number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9166@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9167invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9168unique labels in the assembly output.
9169
9170This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9171if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9172@end defmac
9173
9174@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9175Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9176@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9177On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9178disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9179@end defmac
9180
9181@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9182Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9183extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9184feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9185@end defmac
9186
9187@node File Names and DBX
9188@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9189
9190@c prevent bad page break with this line
9191This describes file names in DBX format.
9192
9193@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9194A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9195@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9196file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9197This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9198
9199This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9200for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9201
9202It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9203text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9204to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9205@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9206@end defmac
9207
9208@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9209Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9210of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9211the beginning of the file.
9212@end defmac
9213
9214@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9215Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9216that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9217an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9218@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9219@end defmac
9220
9221@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9222A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9223compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9224written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9225
9226If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9227of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9228@end defmac
9229
9230@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9231Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9232@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9233the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9234whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9235@end defmac
9236
9237@need 2000
9238@node SDB and DWARF
9239@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9240
9241@c prevent bad page break with this line
9242Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9243
9244@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9245Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9246for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9247@end defmac
9248
9249@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9250Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9251debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9252
9253@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9254Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9255be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9256value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9257@end deftypefn
9258
9259To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9260define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9261@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9262prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9263as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9264@end defmac
9265
9266@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9267Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9268Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
9269(@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
9270information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9271@end defmac
9272
9273@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9274Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9275line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9276tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9277@end defmac
9278
9279@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9280A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9281@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9282@end defmac
9283
9284@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9285A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9286between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9287slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9288@end defmac
9289
9290@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9291A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9292section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9293given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9294@end defmac
9295
9296@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9297A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9298reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9299@end defmac
9300
9301@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9302A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9303the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9304is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9305is referenced by a function.
9306@end defmac
9307
9308@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9309If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9310reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9311@end deftypefn
9312
9313@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9314Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9315SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9316macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9317not define them yourself.
9318@end defmac
9319
9320@defmac SDB_DELIM
9321Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9322SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9323delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9324a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9325required.
9326@end defmac
9327
9328@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9329Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9330union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9331allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9332it.
9333@end defmac
9334
9335@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9336Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9337enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9338assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9339@end defmac
9340
9341@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9342A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9343number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9344@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9345@end defmac
9346
9347@need 2000
9348@node VMS Debug
9349@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9350
9351@c prevent bad page break with this line
9352Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9353
9354@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9355Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9356in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9357is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9358@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9359behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
9360@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9361@end defmac
9362
9363@node Floating Point
9364@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9365@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9366@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9367
9368While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9369there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9370means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9371in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9372doing the compilation.
9373
9374Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9375range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9376the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9377safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9378the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9379emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9380target floating point formats are identical.
9381
9382The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9383use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9384floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9385their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9386
9387@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9388The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9389machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9390array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9391quantity.
9392@end defmac
9393
9394@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9395Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9396floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9397@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9398@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9399@end deftypefn
9400
9401@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9402Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9403@end deftypefn
9404
9405@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9406Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9407@end deftypefn
9408
9409@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9410Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9411@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9412@end deftypefn
9413
9414@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9415Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9416representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9417decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9418defined by the C language for both.
9419@end deftypefn
9420
9421@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9422Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9423@end deftypefn
9424
9425@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9426Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9427@end deftypefn
9428
9429@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9430Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9431@end deftypefn
9432
9433@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9434Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9435@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9436variable).
9437
9438The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9439following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9440@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9441
9442If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9443target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9444@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9445@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9446@end deftypefn
9447
9448@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9449Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9450@end deftypefn
9451
9452@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9453Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9454@end deftypefn
9455
9456@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9457Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9458return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9459appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9460precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9461@end deftypefn
9462
9463@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9464Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9465which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9466integral, it is truncated.
9467@end deftypefn
9468
9469@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9470Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9471into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9472value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9473@end deftypefn
9474
9475@node Mode Switching
9476@section Mode Switching Instructions
9477@cindex mode switching
9478The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9479
9480@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9481Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9482switching in an optimizing compilation.
9483
9484For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9485floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9486the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9487operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9488purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9489be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9490or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9491
9492You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9493which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9494return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9495If you define this macro, you also have to define
9496@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9497@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9498@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9499are optional.
9500@end defmac
9501
9502@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9503If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9504initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9505N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9506of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9507The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9508zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9509entity in question.
9510In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9511represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9512switch is needed / supplied.
9513@end defmac
9514
9515@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9516@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9517@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9518return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9519@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9520be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9521@end defmac
9522
9523@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9524If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9525mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9526different from the incoming mode).
9527@end defmac
9528
9529@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9530If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9531mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9532@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9533is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9534@end defmac
9535
9536@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9537If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9538mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9539@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9540is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9541@end defmac
9542
9543@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9544This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
95450 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9546lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9547for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9548(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9549@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9550@end defmac
9551
9552@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9553Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9554@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9555the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9556@end defmac
9557
9558@node Target Attributes
9559@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9560@cindex target attributes
9561@cindex machine attributes
9562@cindex attributes, target-specific
9563
9564Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9565These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9566be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9567
9568@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9569If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9570attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9571specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9572entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9573take.
9574@end deftypevr
9575
9576@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9577If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9578machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9579given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9580subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9581false for all machine-specific attributes.
9582@end deftypefn
9583
9584@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9585If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9586@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9587and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9588generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9589supposed always to be compatible.
9590@end deftypefn
9591
9592@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9593If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9594the newly defined @var{type}.
9595@end deftypefn
9596
9597@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9598Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9599handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9600@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9601that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9602function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9603merging.
9604@end deftypefn
9605
9606@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9607Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9608handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9609@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9610@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9611when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9612attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9613call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9614
9615@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9616If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9617for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9618@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9619will then define a function called
9620@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9621the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9622add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9623to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9624@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9625@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9626@end deftypefn
9627
9628@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9629
9630@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9631Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9632@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9633default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9634@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9635of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9636on this implementation detail.
9637@end defmac
9638
9639@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9640Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9641when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9642wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9643the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9644created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9645for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9646shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9647the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9648attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9649needed.
9650@end deftypefn
9651
9652@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9653@cindex inlining
9654This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9655into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9656attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9657target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9658@end deftypefn
9659
9660@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9661This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9662it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9663options for the current function that might be different than the
9664options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9665@code{true} if the options are valid.
9666
9667The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9668the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9669@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9670@end deftypefn
9671
9672@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9673This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9674in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9675options.
9676@xref{Option file format}.
9677@end deftypefn
9678
9679@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9680This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9681information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9682function specific options.
9683@end deftypefn
9684
9685@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9686This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9687information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9688function specific options.
9689@end deftypefn
9690
9691@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (target @var{args})
9692This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9693set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9694input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
9695@code{TARGET_VALID_OPTION_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9696@end deftypefn
9697
9698@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9699Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9700a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9701@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9702once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9703
9704Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9705@option{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
9706
9707If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9708changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9709@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9710@end deftypefn
9711
9712@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9713This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9714cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9715default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9716specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9717@end deftypefn
9718
9719@node Emulated TLS
9720@section Emulating TLS
9721@cindex Emulated TLS
9722
9723For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9724specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9725used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9726configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9727the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9728layer.
9729
9730The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9731object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9732which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9733address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9734
9735@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9736Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9737object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9738emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9739@end deftypevr
9740
9741@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9742Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9743program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9744initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9745have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9746registration function to be used.
9747@end deftypevr
9748
9749@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9750Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9751be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9752any section.
9753@end deftypevr
9754
9755@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9756Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9757placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9758section.
9759@end deftypevr
9760
9761@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9762Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9763The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9764@end deftypevr
9765
9766@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9767Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9768default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9769@end deftypevr
9770
9771@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9772Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9773object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9774@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9775@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9776for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9777@end deftypefn
9778
9779@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9780Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9781TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9782is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9783initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9784@end deftypefn
9785
9786@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9787Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9788fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9789single objects. The default is false.
9790@end deftypevr
9791
9792@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9793Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9794may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9795@end deftypevr
9796
9797@node MIPS Coprocessors
9798@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9799@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9800
9801The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9802coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9803accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9804and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9805
9806@smallexample
9807 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9808 unsigned int d;
9809
9810 d = cp0count + 3;
9811@end smallexample
9812
9813(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9814names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9815overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9816
9817Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9818be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9819later in the function.
9820
9821Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9822the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9823floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9824
9825There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9826you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9827
9828@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9829A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9830alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9831@smallexample
9832@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9833@end smallexample
9834Default: empty.
9835@end defmac
9836
9837@node PCH Target
9838@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9839@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9840
9841@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9842This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9843@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9844@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9845@end deftypefn
9846
9847@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9848This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9849compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9850if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9851be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9852
9853@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9854when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9855It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9856compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9857
9858The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9859suitable for most targets.
9860@end deftypefn
9861
9862@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9863If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9864@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9865of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9866@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9867value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9868@end deftypefn
9869
9870@node C++ ABI
9871@section C++ ABI parameters
9872@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9873
9874@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9875Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9876These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9877default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9878@end deftypefn
9879
9880@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9881This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9882@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9883@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9884@end deftypefn
9885
9886@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9887This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9888whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9889known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9890@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9891IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9892@end deftypefn
9893
9894@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9895This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9896array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9897@end deftypefn
9898
9899@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9900If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9901class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9902will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9903to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9904modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9905backend's targeted operating system.
9906@end deftypefn
9907
9908@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9909This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9910the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9911@code{false}.
9912@end deftypefn
9913
9914@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9915This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9916which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9917table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9918Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9919the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9920some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9921method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9922@end deftypefn
9923
9924@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
9925
9926@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
9927This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
9928similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
9929external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
9930classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
9931unit will not be COMDAT.
9932@end deftypefn
9933
9934@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
9935This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
9936the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
9937be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
9938@end deftypefn
9939
9940@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
9941This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
9942should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
9943is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
9944@end deftypefn
9945
9946@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
9947This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
9948in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
9949destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
9950shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
9951unloaded. The default is to return false.
9952@end deftypefn
9953
9954@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
9955
9956@node Named Address Spaces
9957@section Adding support for named address spaces
9958@cindex named address spaces
9959
9960The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
9961standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
9962support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
9963processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
9964GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
9965address spaces other than the default address space. These address
9966spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
9967@code{const} type attributes.
9968
9969Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
9970pointers to the generic address space.
9971
9972For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
9973to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
9974processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
9975issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
9976local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
9977address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
9978@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
9979always 32 bits).
9980
9981Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
9982range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
9983address space.
9984
9985To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
9986the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
9987the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
9988named address space #1:
9989@smallexample
9990#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
9991c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
9992@end smallexample
9993
9994@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
9995Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
9996@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
9997The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
9998generic address space only.
9999@end deftypefn
10000
10001@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10002Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10003@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10004The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10005generic address space only.
10006@end deftypefn
10007
10008@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10009Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10010with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10011hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10012except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10013version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10014@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10015target hooks for the given address space.
10016@end deftypefn
10017
10018@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10019Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10020@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10021parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10022finished. This target hook is the same as the
10023@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10024explicit named address space support.
10025@end deftypefn
10026
10027@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10028Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10029with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10030hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10031except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10032@end deftypefn
10033
10034@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10035Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10036contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10037a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10038will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10039arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10040converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10041@end deftypefn
10042
10043@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10044Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10045@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10046space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10047to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10048guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10049as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10050@end deftypefn
10051
10052@node Misc
10053@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10054@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10055
10056@c prevent bad page break with this line
10057Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10058
10059@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10060Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10061has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10062conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10063blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10064set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10065to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10066@end defmac
10067
10068@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10069Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10070has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10071conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10072blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10073set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10074to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10075@end defmac
10076
10077@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10078An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10079elements of a jump-table should have.
10080@end defmac
10081
10082@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10083Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10084when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10085it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10086To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10087make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10088The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10089flags can be updated.
10090@end defmac
10091
10092@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10093Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10094should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10095jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10096contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10097is in effect.
10098@end defmac
10099
10100@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10101This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10102is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10103The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10104five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10105@end deftypefn
10106
10107@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10108Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10109statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10110advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10111of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10112targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10113@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10114@code{false} otherwise.
10115@end defmac
10116
10117@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10118Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10119smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10120Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10121@end defmac
10122
10123@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10124Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10125memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10126bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10127zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10128of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10129insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10130@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10131
10132This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10133greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10134value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10135@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10136define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10137
10138You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10139the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10140of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10141when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10142integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10143
10144You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10145mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10146@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10147is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10148@end defmac
10149
10150@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10151Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10152extends.
10153@end defmac
10154
10155@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10156Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10157point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10158unsigned one.
10159@end defmac
10160
10161@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10162When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10163divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10164the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10165that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10166of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10167has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10168@end deftypefn
10169
10170@defmac MOVE_MAX
10171The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10172between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10173@end defmac
10174
10175@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10176The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10177between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10178is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10179constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10180at run-time.
10181@end defmac
10182
10183@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10184A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10185actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10186of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10187this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10188a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10189truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10190instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10191include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10192also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10193arguments to bit-field instructions.
10194
10195If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10196position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10197instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10198
10199However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10200only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10201bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10202such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10203the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10204
10205You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10206@end defmac
10207
10208@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10209@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10210This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10211deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10212@xref{shift patterns}.
10213
10214On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10215shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10216equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10217this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10218otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10219particular behavior is guaranteed.
10220
10221Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10222@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10223that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10224
10225The default implementation of this function returns
10226@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10227and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10228@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10229nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10230by overriding it.
10231@end deftypefn
10232
10233@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10234A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10235``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10236bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10237operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10238
10239On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10240
10241@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10242@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10243When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10244modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10245If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10246such cases may improve things.
10247@end defmac
10248
10249@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10250The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10251are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10252@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10253sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10254otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10255representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10256@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10257@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10258@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10259widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10260
10261Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10262value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10263as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10264@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10265
10266Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10267describe two related properties. If you define
10268@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10269to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10270extension.
10271
10272In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10273@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10274@code{mode}.
10275@end deftypefn
10276
10277@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10278A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10279with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10280(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10281apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10282comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10283
10284A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10285comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10286and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10287which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10288true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10289operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10290@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10291@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10292the compiler.
10293
10294If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10295generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10296replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10297the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10298For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10299@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10300@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10301expression
10302
10303@smallexample
10304(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10305@end smallexample
10306
10307@noindent
10308can be converted to
10309
10310@smallexample
10311(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10312@end smallexample
10313
10314@noindent
10315where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10316tested into the sign bit.
10317
10318There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10319for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10320but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10321are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10322perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10323comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10324
10325Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10326from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10327choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10328to be used:
10329
10330@itemize @bullet
10331@item
10332Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10333@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10334``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10335comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10336combine the normalization with other operations.
10337
10338@item
10339For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10340slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10341other machines.
10342
10343@item
10344As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10345exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10346others.
10347
10348@item
10349Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10350@end itemize
10351
10352Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10353@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10354instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10355those cases, e.g., one matching
10356
10357@smallexample
10358(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10359@end smallexample
10360
10361Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10362condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10363@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10364machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10365and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10366@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10367@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10368find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10369
10370If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10371not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10372instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10373@end defmac
10374
10375@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10376A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10377returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10378Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10379floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10380this macro.
10381@end defmac
10382
10383@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10384A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10385for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10386mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10387this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10388return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10389this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10390@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10391the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10392given mode.
10393@end defmac
10394
10395@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10396@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10397A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10398for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10399A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10400If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10401evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10402entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10403the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10404In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10405this value.
10406
10407If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10408@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10409
10410This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10411relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10412is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10413to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10414
10415Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10416and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10417visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10418to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10419breaking the API@.
10420@end defmac
10421
10422@defmac Pmode
10423An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10424this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10425pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10426On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10427modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10428
10429The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10430@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10431@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10432to @code{Pmode}.
10433@end defmac
10434
10435@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10436An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10437being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10438where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10439@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10440size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10441as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10442@end defmac
10443
10444@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10445In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10446constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10447hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10448where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10449strict conformance to the C Standard.
10450
10451Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10452convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10453files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10454@end defmac
10455
10456@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10457Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10458This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10459C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10460@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10461@end defmac
10462
10463@findex #pragma
10464@findex pragma
10465@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10466Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10467If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10468@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10469for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10470setup required for the pragmas.
10471
10472The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10473other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10474definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10475
10476If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10477defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10478
10479Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10480@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10481silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10482@end defmac
10483
10484@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10485@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10486
10487Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10488@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10489@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10490pragma of the form
10491
10492@smallexample
10493#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10494@end smallexample
10495
10496@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10497@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10498routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10499on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10500@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10501callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10502a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10503arguments of pragmas registered with
10504@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10505pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10506
10507Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10508compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10509other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10510to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10511building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10512variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10513target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10514the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10515code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10516rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10517how to build this object file.
10518@end deftypefun
10519
10520@findex #pragma
10521@findex pragma
10522@defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
10523Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
10524pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
10525[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
10526
10527The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
10528within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
10529@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
10530the behavior to the default.
10531
10532A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
10533(e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
10534When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
10535of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
10536bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
10537and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
10538chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
10539size is allocated).
10540
10541If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
10542the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
10543used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
10544precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
10545may affect its placement.
10546
10547The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
10548@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
10549of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
10550@end defmac
10551
10552@findex #pragma
10553@findex pragma
10554@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
10555Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
10556style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
10557pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
10558alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
10559the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
10560pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
10561invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
10562that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
10563value.
10564@end defmac
10565
10566@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10567Define this macro, as well as
10568@code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
10569arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10570@end defmac
10571
10572@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10573
10574@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10575If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10576the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10577This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10578@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10579@end defmac
10580
10581@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10582Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10583identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10584not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10585there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10586@end defmac
10587
10588@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10589Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10590@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10591G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10592@samp{.} is used instead.
10593@end defmac
10594
10595@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10596Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10597@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10598have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10599are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10600@end defmac
10601
10602@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10603Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10604delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10605even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10606@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10607every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10608or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10609you should define this macro.
10610
10611You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10612@end defmac
10613
10614@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10615Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10616delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10617even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10618@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10619some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10620are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10621define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10622instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10623slot of @var{insn}.
10624
10625You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10626@end defmac
10627
10628@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10629Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10630global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10631symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10632instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10633from shared libraries (DLLs).
10634
10635You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10636@end defmac
10637
10638@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10639This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10640any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10641It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10642clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10643corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10644clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10645@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10646for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10647@end deftypefn
10648
10649@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10650Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10651in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10652separate math library.
10653
10654You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
10655@end defmac
10656
10657@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10658Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10659specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10660
10661You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10662is wrong.
10663@end defmac
10664
10665@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10666Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10667functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10668Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10669to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10670if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10671for cross-profiling.
10672@end defmac
10673
10674@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10675
10676A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10677conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10678@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
106791 if it does use cc0.
10680@end defmac
10681
10682@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10683Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10684conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10685@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10686contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10687and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10688then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10689@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10690@end defmac
10691
10692@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10693Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10694if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10695@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10696being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10697@end defmac
10698
10699@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10700A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10701be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10702a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10703about the currently processed blocks.
10704@end defmac
10705
10706@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10707A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10708converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10709can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10710to by @var{ce_info}.
10711@end defmac
10712
10713@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10714A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10715converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10716can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10717to by @var{ce_info}.
10718@end defmac
10719
10720@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10721A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10722structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10723@end defmac
10724
10725@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10726If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10727added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10728by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10729@end defmac
10730
10731@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10732If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10733instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10734just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10735
10736The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10737it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10738laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10739Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10740
10741You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10742definition is null.
10743@end deftypefn
10744
10745@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10746Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10747that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10748necessary setup.
10749
10750Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10751instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10752they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10753instructions or prefetch instructions).
10754
10755To create a built-in function, call the function
10756@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10757which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10758up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10759only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10760@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10761@end deftypefn
10762
10763@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10764Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10765that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10766builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10767If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10768if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10769If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10770@code{error_mark_node}.
10771@end deftypefn
10772
10773@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10774
10775Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10776@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10777function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10778convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10779@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10780@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10781ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10782built-in function.
10783@end deftypefn
10784
10785@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
10786
10787Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10788was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10789@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10790implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10791declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10792arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10793complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10794another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10795@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10796@end deftypefn
10797
10798@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
10799
10800Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10801@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10802built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10803the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10804The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10805call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10806@end deftypefn
10807
10808@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10809
10810Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10811low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10812could not be applied.
10813
10814Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10815instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10816the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10817By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10818loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10819@end deftypefn
10820
10821@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10822
10823Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10824Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10825@var{branch2} is possible.
10826
10827On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10828filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10829may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10830@end defmac
10831
10832@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10833This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10834Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10835PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10836of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10837@end deftypefn
10838
10839@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10840
10841When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10842register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10843to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10844it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10845is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10846that had its initial value copied by using
10847@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10848Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10849to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10850the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10851@code{MEM}.
10852If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10853it might decide to use another register anyways.
10854You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10855that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10856register in question will not be clobbered.
10857The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10858allocation.
10859@end deftypefn
10860
10861@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10862This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10863@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10864this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10865@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10866to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10867passed along.
10868@end deftypefn
10869
10870@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10871The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10872context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10873the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10874per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10875attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10876The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10877and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10878and is returning to processing at the top level.
10879The default hook function does nothing.
10880
10881GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10882some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10883situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10884or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10885@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10886outside of any function scope.
10887@end deftypefn
10888
10889@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10890Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10891files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10892use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10893@end defmac
10894
10895@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10896Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10897automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10898do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10899executable files.
10900@end defmac
10901
10902@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10903If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10904specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10905Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10906object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10907lists.
10908@end defmac
10909
10910@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10911Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10912method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10913must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10914For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10915the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10916defined as this expression:
10917
10918@smallexample
10919build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10920 build_tree_list
10921 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10922 NULL))
10923@end smallexample
10924@end defmac
10925
10926@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10927This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10928instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10929every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10930reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10931
10932@smallexample
10933static bool
10934cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10935@{
10936 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10937@}
10938@end smallexample
10939@end deftypefn
10940
10941@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10942This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10943optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10944usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10945re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10946to inter-block scheduling.
10947@end deftypefn
10948
10949@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10950Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10951registers
10952that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10953returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10954that all target registers in the class returned by
10955@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10956saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10957epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10958true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10959to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10960to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10961@end deftypefn
10962
10963@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
10964This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10965This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10966modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10967@end deftypefn
10968
10969@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
10970This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10971should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
10972the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
10973the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
10974is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
10975number of memory accesses.
10976@end deftypefn
10977
10978@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
10979If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
10980that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
10981that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
10982constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
10983more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
10984system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
10985The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
10986@end defmac
10987
10988@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10989This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10990target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
10991are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
10992The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
10993@end deftypefn
10994
10995@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10996This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10997target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
10998indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
10999@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11000@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11001@end deftypefn
11002
11003@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11004This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11005The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11006systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11007that are different from @option{-I}.
11008@end deftypefn
11009
11010@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11011This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11012for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11013@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11014functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11015@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11016@end defmac
11017
11018@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11019If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11020target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11021option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11022@end defmac
11023
11024@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11025If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11026@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11027@end defmac
11028
11029@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11030If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11031target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11032default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11033@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11034@end defmac
11035
11036@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11037If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11038@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11039@end defmac
11040
11041@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11042If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11043routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11044and scanf formatter settings.
11045@end defmac
11046
11047@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11048If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11049guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11050main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11051important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11052many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11053``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11054and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11055@end deftypevr
11056
11057@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11058If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11059illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11060with prototype @var{typelist}.
11061@end deftypefn
11062
11063@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11064If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11065invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11066if validity should be determined by the front end.
11067@end deftypefn
11068
11069@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11070If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11071invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11072@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11073if validity should be determined by the front end.
11074@end deftypefn
11075
11076@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11077If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11078invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11079and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11080the front end.
11081@end deftypefn
11082
11083@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11084If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11085invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11086or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11087the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11088@end deftypefn
11089
11090@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11091If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11092invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11093or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11094the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11095@end deftypefn
11096
11097@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11098If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11099@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11100analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11101front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11102target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11103This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11104@end deftypefn
11105
11106@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11107If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11108@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11109or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11110This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11111conversion rules.
11112This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11113@end deftypefn
11114
11115@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11116This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11117classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11118SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11119@end defmac
11120
11121@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11122This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11123NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11124@end defmac
11125
11126@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11127Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11128to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11129call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11130and the associated definitions of those functions.
11131@end defmac
11132
11133@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11134Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11135necessary.
11136@end deftypefn
11137
11138@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11139This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11140different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11141argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11142is needed.
11143@end deftypefn
11144
11145@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11146When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11147arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11148stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11149debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11150@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11151cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11152to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11153false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11154@end deftypefn
11155
11156@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11157On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11158a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11159is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11160is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11161subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11162the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11163available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11164constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11165down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11166@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11167accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11168value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11169MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11170@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11171is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr